blob: 9447e4d208a423e9fa41eff39945fbe25ff5f20d [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000183 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000184 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000187 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
190 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000191 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
192 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000193 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000196 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
197 Instruction *LHS,
198 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000199 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
200 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000201
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000202 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
203 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000204 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000205 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000206 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000208 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000209 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000214 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
215 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000216 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
218 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000219 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000220 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000221 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
222 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000223 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
224 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000225 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
226 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000227 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
228 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000229 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000230 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000231 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000232 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000233 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000234 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000235 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000236 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000237 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000238 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000239
240 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000241 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000242
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000243 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000244 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000245 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000246 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000247 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
248 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000249 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000250
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000251 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000252 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
253 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
254 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000255 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000256 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
257 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000258 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
259 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000260 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000261 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000262 }
263
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000264 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
265 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
266 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000267 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
268 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000269 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000270
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000271 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000272 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000273
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000274 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000275 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000276 return C;
277 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000278
279 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
280 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
281 }
282
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000283
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000284 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
285 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
286 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
287 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
288 // modified.
289 //
290 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000291 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000292 if (&I != V) {
293 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
294 return &I;
295 } else {
296 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
297 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000298 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000299 return &I;
300 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000301 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000302
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000303 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
304 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
305 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
306 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
307 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
308 //
309 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
310 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
311 if (Old != New)
312 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
313 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000314 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000315 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000316 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000317 return true;
318 }
319
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000320 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
321 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
322 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
323 // this function.
324 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
325 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
326 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000327 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000328 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000329 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
330 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000331
332 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
333 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
334 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
335 }
336
337 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
338 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
339 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
340 }
341 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
342 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
343 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000344
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000345 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000346 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
347 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
348 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
349 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000350 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
351 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000352 Instruction *InsertBefore);
353
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000354 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
355 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000356 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000357
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000358 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
359 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
360 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
361
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000362 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
363 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000364 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
365 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
366 unsigned Depth = 0);
367
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000368 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
369 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
370
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000371 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
372 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
373 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
374 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
375
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000376 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
377 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
378 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000380 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
381
382
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000383 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
384 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000385
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000386 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000387 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000388 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000389 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000390 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000391 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000392 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000394 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000395
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000396
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000397 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000399 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
400 unsigned CastOpc,
401 int &NumCastsRemoved);
402 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
403 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000404
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000405 };
406}
407
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000408char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
409static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
410X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
411
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000412// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000413// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000414static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
415 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
416 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000417 return 3;
418 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000419 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000420 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
421 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000422}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000423
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000424// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
425// it.
426static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000427 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000428}
429
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000430// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
431// though a va_arg area...
432static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000433 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
434 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
435 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000436 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000437 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000438}
439
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000440/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
441/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
442/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000443static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
444 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000445 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000446 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000447 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
448 // GetElementPtrInst?
449 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
450 return GEP->getOperand(0);
451 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000452 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000453 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000454 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000455 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
456 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
457 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
458 I != E; ++I) {
459 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
460 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
461 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
462 return 0;
463 }
464 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
465 return CE->getOperand(0);
466 }
467 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000468 return 0;
469}
470
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000471/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
472/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000473static Instruction::CastOps
474isEliminableCastPair(
475 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
476 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
477 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
478 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
479) {
480
481 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
482 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000483
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000484 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
485 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
486 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000487
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000488 return Instruction::CastOps(
489 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
490 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000491}
492
493/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
494/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
495/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000496static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
497 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000498 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
499
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000500 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000501 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000502 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000503 return false;
504 return true;
505}
506
507/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
508/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
509/// casts that are known to not do anything...
510///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000511Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
512 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000513 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
514 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
515 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000516 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000517
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000518 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000519}
520
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000521// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
522// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000523//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000524// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
525// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
526// binary operators.
527//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000528// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
529// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000530//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000531bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000532 bool Changed = false;
533 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
534 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000535
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000536 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
537 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000538 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
539 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
540 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000541 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
542 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
543 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000544 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
545 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
546 return true;
547 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
548 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
549 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
550 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
551 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
552
553 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000554 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000555 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000556 Op1->getOperand(0),
557 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000558 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000559 I.setOperand(0, New);
560 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
561 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000562 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000563 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000564 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000565}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000566
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000567/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
568/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
569/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
570bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
571 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
572 return false;
573 I.swapOperands();
574 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
575 return true;
576}
577
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000578// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
579// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000580//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000581static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
582 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000583 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000584
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000585 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
586 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
587 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000588
589 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
590 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
591 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
592
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000593 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000594}
595
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000596static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
597 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000598 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000599
600 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000601 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000602 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000603 return 0;
604}
605
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000606// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
607// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000608// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
609// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000610//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000611static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000612 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000613 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000614 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000615 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000616 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000617 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000618 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000619 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000620 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000621 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000622 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000623 return I->getOperand(0);
624 }
625 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000626 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000627}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000628
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000629/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
630/// expression, return it.
631static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
632 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
633 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
634 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
635 return cast<User>(V);
636 return false;
637}
638
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000639/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
640/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000641static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
642 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000643 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000644 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000645 return CE->getOpcode();
646 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
647 return Instruction::UserOp1;
648}
649
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000650/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000651static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000652 APInt Val(C->getValue());
653 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000654}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000655/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000656static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000657 APInt Val(C->getValue());
658 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000659}
660/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
661static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
662 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
663}
664/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
665static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
666 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
667}
668/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
669static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
670 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
671}
672/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
673static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
674 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000675}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000676/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
677/// this size.
678static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
679 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
680 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
681 if (sign) {
682 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
684 } else {
685 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
687 }
688
689 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
690
691 if (sign) {
692 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
694 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
695 } else
696 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
697}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000698
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000699
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000700/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
701/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
702/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
703/// constant and return true.
704static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000705 APInt Demanded) {
706 assert(I && "No instruction?");
707 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
708
709 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
710 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
711 if (!OpC) return false;
712
713 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
714 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
715 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
716 return false;
717
718 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
719 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
720 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
721 return true;
722}
723
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000724// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
725// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
726// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
727// min/max.
728static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000729 const APInt& KnownZero,
730 const APInt& KnownOne,
731 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
732 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
733 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
736 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000737 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000739 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
740 // bit if it is unknown.
741 Min = KnownOne;
742 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
743
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000744 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000745 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
746 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000748}
749
750// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
751// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
752// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
753// min/max.
754static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000755 const APInt &KnownZero,
756 const APInt &KnownOne,
757 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
758 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000759 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
761 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
762 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000763 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000764
765 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
766 Min = KnownOne;
767 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
768 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
769}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000770
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000771/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
772/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
773/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
774/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
775/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
776/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
777/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
778/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
779/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
780/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
781/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
782/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
783/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
784/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
785/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
786bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
787 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
788 unsigned Depth) {
789 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
790 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
791 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
792 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
793 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
796 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
797 must have same BitWidth");
798 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
799 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
800 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
801 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
802 return false;
803 }
804
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000805 KnownZero.clear();
806 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000807 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
808 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
809 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
810 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
811 return false;
812 }
813 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
814 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
815 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
816 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
817 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
818 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
819 return false;
820 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
821 return false;
822 }
823
824 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
825 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
826
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000827 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
828 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
829 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000830 default:
831 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
832 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000833 case Instruction::And:
834 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
835 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
836 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
837 return true;
838 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
839 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
840
841 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
842 // LHS.
843 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
844 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
845 return true;
846 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
847 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
848
849 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
850 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
851 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
852 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
853 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
854 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
855 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
856 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
857
858 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
859 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
860 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
861
862 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
863 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
864 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
865
866 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
867 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
868 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
869 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
870 break;
871 case Instruction::Or:
872 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
873 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
874 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
875 return true;
876 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
877 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
878 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
879 // LHS.
880 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
881 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
882 return true;
883 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
884 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
885
886 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
887 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
888 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
889 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
890 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
891 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
892 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
893 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
894
895 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
896 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
897 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
898 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
899 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
900 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
901 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
902 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
903
904 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
905 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
906 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
907
908 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
909 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
910 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
911 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
912 break;
913 case Instruction::Xor: {
914 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
915 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
916 return true;
917 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
918 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
919 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
920 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
921 return true;
922 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
923 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
924
925 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
926 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
927 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
928 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
929 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
930 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
931
932 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
933 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
934 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
935 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
936 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
937 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
938
939 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
940 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
941 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
942 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
943 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000944 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000945 I->getName());
946 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
947 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
948 }
949
950 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
951 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
952 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
953 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
954 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
955 // all known
956 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
957 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
958 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000959 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000960 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
961 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
962 }
963 }
964
965 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
966 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
967 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
968 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
969
970 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
971 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
972 break;
973 }
974 case Instruction::Select:
975 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
976 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
977 return true;
978 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
979 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
980 return true;
981 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
982 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
983 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
984 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
985
986 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
987 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
988 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
989 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
990 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
991
992 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
993 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
994 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
995 break;
996 case Instruction::Trunc: {
997 uint32_t truncBf =
998 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000999 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1001 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1002 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1003 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001004 return true;
1005 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1008 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1009 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1010 break;
1011 }
1012 case Instruction::BitCast:
1013 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1014 return false;
1015
1016 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1017 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1018 return true;
1019 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1020 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1021 break;
1022 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1023 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1024 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001025 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001026
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001027 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1029 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001030 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1031 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001032 return true;
1033 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1036 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1037 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1038 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001039 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001040 break;
1041 }
1042 case Instruction::SExt: {
1043 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1044 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001045 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001047 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001048 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001049
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001050 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001051 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1052 // bit is demanded.
1053 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001054 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001055
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001056 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1058 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001059 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1060 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001061 return true;
1062 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1064 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1065 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1066 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1067
1068 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1069 // top bits of the result.
1070
1071 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1072 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001073 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001074 {
1075 // Convert to ZExt cast
1076 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1077 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001078 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001079 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001080 }
1081 break;
1082 }
1083 case Instruction::Add: {
1084 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1085 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1086 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001087 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001088
1089 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1090 // we can do.
1091 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1092 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1093 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1094 if (RHS->isZero())
1095 break;
1096
1097 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1098 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001099 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001100
1101 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1102 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1103 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1104 return true;
1105
1106 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1107 // the constant.
1108 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1109 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1110
1111 // Avoid excess work.
1112 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1113 break;
1114
1115 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1116 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1117 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001118 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001119 I->getName());
1120 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1121 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1122 }
1123
1124 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1125 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1126 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1127 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1128 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1129
1130 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1131 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1132 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001133 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1134 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001135
1136 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1137
1138 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1139 // other, and there is no input carry.
1140 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1141 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1142
1143 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1144 // is no input carry.
1145 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1146 } else {
1147 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1148 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001149 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1151 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001152 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001153 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1154 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1155 return true;
1156 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1157 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1158 return true;
1159 }
1160 }
1161 break;
1162 }
1163 case Instruction::Sub:
1164 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1165 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001166 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001167 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1168 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001169 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001170 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001171 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1172 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1173 return true;
1174 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1175 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1176 return true;
1177 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001178 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1179 // the known zeros and ones.
1180 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181 break;
1182 case Instruction::Shl:
1183 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001184 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001185 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1186 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001187 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1188 return true;
1189 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1190 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1191 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1193 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001194 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001195 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001196 }
1197 break;
1198 case Instruction::LShr:
1199 // For a logical shift right
1200 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001201 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001203 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001204 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1205 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001206 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1207 return true;
1208 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1209 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001210 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1211 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001212 if (ShiftAmt) {
1213 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001214 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001215 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1216 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217 }
1218 break;
1219 case Instruction::AShr:
1220 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1221 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1222 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1223 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1224 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1225 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001226 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001227 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1228 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1229 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1230 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001231
1232 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1233 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1234 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1235 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001236
1237 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001238 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001239
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001240 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001241 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001242 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1243 // demanded.
1244 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1245 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001246 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001247 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001248 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1249 return true;
1250 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1251 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1252 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001253 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001254 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1255 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1256
1257 // Handle the sign bits.
1258 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1259 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1260 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1261
1262 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1263 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001264 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001265 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1266 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001267 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1269 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1270 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1271 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1272 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1273 }
1274 }
1275 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001276 case Instruction::SRem:
1277 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001278 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1279 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001280 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1281 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1282
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001283 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001284 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1285 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1286 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1287 return true;
1288
1289 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1290 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001291
1292 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001293
1294 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1295 }
1296 }
1297 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001299 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1300 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001301 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1302 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1303 return true;
1304
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001305 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001306 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001307 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1308 return true;
1309
1310 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1311 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1312 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001313 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001314 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001315 case Instruction::Call:
1316 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1317 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1318 default: break;
1319 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1320 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1321 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1322 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1323 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1324
1325 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1326 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1327 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1328 NLZ &= ~7;
1329 NTZ &= ~7;
1330 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1331 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1332 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1333 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1334
1335 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1336 // the right place.
1337 Instruction *NewVal;
1338 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1339 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1340 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1341 else
1342 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1343 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1344 NewVal->takeName(I);
1345 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1346 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1347 }
1348
1349 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1350 break;
1351 }
1352 }
1353 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001354 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001355 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001356 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001357
1358 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1359 // constant.
1360 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1361 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1362 return false;
1363}
1364
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001365
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001366/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001367/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1368/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1369/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1370///
1371/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1372/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1373/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1374Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1375 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1376 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001377 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001378 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1379 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001380 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001381
1382 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1383 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1384 UndefElts = EltMask;
1385 return 0;
1386 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1387 UndefElts = EltMask;
1388 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1389 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001390
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001391 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001392 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1393 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001394 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1395
1396 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1397 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1398 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1399 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1400 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1401 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1402 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1403 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1404 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1405 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1406 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001407
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001408 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001409 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001410 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1411 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001412 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001413 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001414
1415 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1416 // anything.
1417 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1418 return 0;
1419
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001420 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001421 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1422 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1423 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1424 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1425 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1426 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001427 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001428 }
1429
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001430 // Limit search depth.
1431 if (Depth == 10)
1432 return false;
1433
1434 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1435 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1436 // are needed.
1437 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1438 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1439 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1440 // the main instcombine process.
1441 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001442 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1443 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001444
1445 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1446 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001447 }
1448
1449 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1450 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1451
1452 bool MadeChange = false;
1453 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1454 Value *TmpV;
1455 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1456 default: break;
1457
1458 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1459 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1460 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001461 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001462 if (Idx == 0) {
1463 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1464 // which elt is getting updated.
1465 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1466 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1467 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1468 break;
1469 }
1470
1471 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1472 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001473 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001474 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1475 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1476
1477 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1478 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1479 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1480 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1481 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1482 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1483
1484 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001485 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1486 break;
1487 }
1488 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1489 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001490 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1491 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001492 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1493 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1494 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1495 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1496 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001497 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001498 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001499 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001500 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1501 else
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001502 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001503 }
1504 }
1505 }
1506
1507 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1508 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1509 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1510
1511 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1512 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1513 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1514 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1515
1516 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1517 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1518 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001519 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001520 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1521 UndefElts |= NewBit;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001522 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001523 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1524 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1525 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1526 } else {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001527 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - LHSVWidth)) & 1) << i;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001528 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1529 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1530 }
1531 }
1532
1533 if (NewUndefElts) {
1534 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1535 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1536 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1537 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1538 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1539 else
1540 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1541 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1542 }
1543 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1544 MadeChange = true;
1545 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001546 break;
1547 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001548 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001549 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001550 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1551 if (!VTy) break;
1552 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1553 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1554 unsigned Ratio;
1555
1556 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001557 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001558 // elements as are demanded of us.
1559 Ratio = 1;
1560 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1561 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1562 // Untested so far.
1563 break;
1564
1565 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1566 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1567 // elements are live.
1568 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1569 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1570 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1571 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1572 }
1573 } else {
1574 // Untested so far.
1575 break;
1576
1577 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1578 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1579 // live.
1580 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1581 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1582 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1583 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1584 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001585
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001586 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1587 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1588 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1589 if (TmpV) {
1590 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1591 MadeChange = true;
1592 }
1593
1594 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1595 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1596 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1597 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1598 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1599 // undef.
1600 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1601 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1602 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1603 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1604 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1605 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1606 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1607 // elements are undef.
1608 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1609 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1610 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1611 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1612 }
1613 break;
1614 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001615 case Instruction::And:
1616 case Instruction::Or:
1617 case Instruction::Xor:
1618 case Instruction::Add:
1619 case Instruction::Sub:
1620 case Instruction::Mul:
1621 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1622 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1623 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1624 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1625 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1626 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1627 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1628
1629 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1630 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1631 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1632 break;
1633
1634 case Instruction::Call: {
1635 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1636 if (!II) break;
1637 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1638 default: break;
1639
1640 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1641 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1643 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1644 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1647 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1648 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1649 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1650 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1651 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1652 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1653 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1654 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1655 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1656
1657 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1658 // scalarize it now.
1659 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1660 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1661 default: break;
1662 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1663 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1664 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1665 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1666 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1667 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1668 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1669 // Extract the element as scalars.
1670 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1671 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1672
1673 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1674 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1675 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1676 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001677 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001678 II->getName()), *II);
1679 break;
1680 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1681 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001682 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001683 II->getName()), *II);
1684 break;
1685 }
1686
1687 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001688 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1689 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001690 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1691 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1692 return New;
1693 }
1694 }
1695
1696 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1697 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1698 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1699 break;
1700 }
1701 break;
1702 }
1703 }
1704 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1705}
1706
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001707
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001708/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1709/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1710/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1711/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1712/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1713/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1714/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1715///
1716template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001717static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001718 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1719 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1720
1721 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1722 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1723 return F.apply(Root);
1724
1725 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1726 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001727 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001728 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1729 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1730
1731 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1732 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1733 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1734 ShouldApply = true;
1735 }
1736
1737 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1738 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1739 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001740 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1741 // and perform the reassociation.
1742 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1743
1744 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1745 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1746
1747 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1748 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001749 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001750 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1751 return 0;
1752 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001753 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001754 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001755 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001756 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001757 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001758
1759 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1760 // get to LHSI.
1761 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1762 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001763 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1764 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001765 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001766 ARI = NextLHSI;
1767
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001768 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1769 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1770 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1771 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1772 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001773
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001774 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1775 // the transformation...
1776 return F.apply(Root);
1777 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001778
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001779 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1780 }
1781 return 0;
1782}
1783
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001784namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001786// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001787struct AddRHS {
1788 Value *RHS;
1789 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1790 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1791 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001792 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1793 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001794 }
1795};
1796
1797// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1798// iff C1&C2 == 0
1799struct AddMaskingAnd {
1800 Constant *C2;
1801 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1802 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001803 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001804 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001805 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001806 }
1807 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001808 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001809 }
1810};
1811
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001812}
1813
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001814static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001815 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001816 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001817 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001818 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001819
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001820 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001821 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001822 }
1823
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001824 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001825 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1826 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001827
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001828 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1829 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001830 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1831 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001832 }
1833
1834 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1835 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1836 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1837 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001838 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001839 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001840 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001841 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001842 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001843 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001844 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001845 abort();
1846 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001847 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1848}
1849
1850// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1851// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1852// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1853// not have a second operand.
1854static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1855 InstCombiner *IC) {
1856 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1857 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1858 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1859 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1860
1861 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001862 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001863 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001864
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001865 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1866 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1867
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001868 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1869 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001870 }
1871 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001872}
1873
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001874
1875/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1876/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1877/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1878Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1879 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001880 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001881 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001882
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001883 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1884 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001885 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001886 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1887 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1888 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1889 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001890 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001891 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1892
1893 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1894 // loop.
1895 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1896 return 0;
1897 }
1898
1899 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1900 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1901 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1902 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1903 if (NonConstBB) {
1904 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1905 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1906 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001907
1908 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001909 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001910 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001911 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001912 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001913
1914 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1915 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1916 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001917 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001918 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001920 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1921 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1922 else
1923 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001924 } else {
1925 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1926 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001927 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001928 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1929 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001930 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001931 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001932 CI->getPredicate(),
1933 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1934 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001935 else
1936 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1937
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001938 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001939 }
1940 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001941 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001942 } else {
1943 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1944 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001945 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001946 Value *InV;
1947 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001948 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001949 } else {
1950 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001951 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001952 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1953 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001954 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001955 }
1956 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001957 }
1958 }
1959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1960}
1961
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001962
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001963/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1964/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1965/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1966/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1967bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1968 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1969 // ones.
1970
1971 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1972 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1973 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1974 // sign extend fine.
1975 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1976 return true;
1977
1978
1979 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1980 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1981 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1982 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1983
1984 // TODO: Implement.
1985
1986 return false;
1987}
1988
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001989
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001990Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001991 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001992 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001993
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001994 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001995 // X + undef -> undef
1996 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1998
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001999 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002000 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002001 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2002 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002003 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002004 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
2005 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002006 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002007 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002008
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002009 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002010 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002011 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002012 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002013 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002014 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002015
2016 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2017 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002018 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2019 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2020 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2021 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2022 return &I;
2023 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002024
2025 // zext(i1) - 1 -> select i1, 0, -1
2026 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
2027 if (CI->isAllOnesValue() &&
2028 ZI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2029 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0),
2030 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2031 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002032 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002033
2034 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2035 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2036 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002037
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002038 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2039 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002040 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2041 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002042 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002043 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002044
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002045 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002046 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2047 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002048 do {
2049 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002050 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2051 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002052 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2053 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002054 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002055 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2056 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002057 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002058 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002059 }
2060 }
2061 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002062 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2063 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2064 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002065
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002066 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002067 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2068 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2069 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002070 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2071 switch (Size) {
2072 default: break;
2073 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2074 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2075 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2076 }
2077 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002078 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002079 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002080 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002081 }
2082 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002083 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002084
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002085 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2086 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2087
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002088 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002089 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002090 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002091
2092 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2093 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2094 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2095 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2096 }
2097 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2098 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2099 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2100 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2101 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002102 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002103
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002104 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002105 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2106 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002107 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2108 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002109 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002110 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002111 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002112 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002113 }
2114
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002115 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002116 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002117
2118 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002119 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2120 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002121 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002122
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002123
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002124 ConstantInt *C2;
2125 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2126 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002127 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002128
2129 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2130 ConstantInt *C1;
2131 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002132 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002133 }
2134
2135 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002136 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002137 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002138
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002139 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002140 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2141 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002142
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002143
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002144 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002145 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002146 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2147 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002148
2149 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2150 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2151 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2152 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2153 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2154 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2155 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2156 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2157 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2158 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2159
2160 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002161 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002162 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002163 }
2164 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002165
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002166 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002167 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002168 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2169 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2170 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2171 if (W != Y) {
2172 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002173 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002174 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002175 std::swap(W, X);
2176 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002177 std::swap(Y, Z);
2178 std::swap(W, X);
2179 }
2180 }
2181
2182 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002183 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002184 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002185 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002186 }
2187 }
2188 }
2189
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002190 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002191 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002192 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002193 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002194
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002195 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2196 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002197 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002198 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2199 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2200 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002201 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002202
2203 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002204 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002205
2206 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002207 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002208
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002209 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2210 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002211 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002212 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002213 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002214 }
2215 }
2216 }
2217
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002218 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2219 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002220 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002221 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002222 }
2223
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002224 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002225 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002226 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002227 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2228 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002229 if (!CI) {
2230 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2231 Other = LHS;
2232 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002233 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002234 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2235 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002236 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002237 unsigned AS =
2238 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002239 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2240 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002241 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002242 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002243 }
2244 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002245
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002246 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002247 {
2248 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002249 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002250 if (!SI) {
2251 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002252 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002253 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002254 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002255 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2256 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002257 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002258
2259 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2260 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002261 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2262 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002263 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002264 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2265 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002266 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002267 }
2268 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002269
2270 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2271 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2272 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002274
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002275 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2276 // integer add followed by a sext.
2277 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2278 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2279 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2280 Constant *CI =
2281 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2282 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2283 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2284 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2285 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2286 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2287 CI, "addconv");
2288 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2289 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2290 }
2291 }
2292
2293 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2294 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2295 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2296 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2297 // integer add will not overflow.
2298 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2299 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2300 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2301 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2302 // Insert the new integer add.
2303 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2304 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2305 "addconv");
2306 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2307 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2308 }
2309 }
2310 }
2311
2312 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2313 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2314 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2315 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2316 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2317 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2318 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2319 // instcombined.
2320 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2321 Constant *CI =
2322 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2323 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2324 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2325 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2326 // Insert the new integer add.
2327 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2328 CI, "addconv");
2329 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2330 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2331 }
2332 }
2333
2334 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2335 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2336 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2337 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2338 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2339 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2340 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2341 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2342 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2343 // Insert the new integer add.
2344 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2345 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2346 "addconv");
2347 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2348 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2349 }
2350 }
2351 }
2352
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002353 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002354}
2355
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002356Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002357 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002358
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002359 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2360 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002362
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002363 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002364 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002365 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002366
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002367 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2369 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2371
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002372 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2373 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002374 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002375 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002376
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002377 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002378 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002379 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002380 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002381
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002382 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2383 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002384 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002385 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002386 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002387 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002388 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002389 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002390 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002391 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002392 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002393 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002394 }
2395 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002396 }
2397 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2398 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2399 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002400 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002401 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002402 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002403 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002404 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002405 }
2406 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002407 }
2408 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002409 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002410
2411 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2412 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002413 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002414 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002415
2416 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2417 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2418 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002419 }
2420
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002421 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2422 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2423
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002424 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2425 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002426 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002427 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002428 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002429 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002430 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002431 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2432 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2433 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002434 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002435 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2436 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002437 }
2438
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002439 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002440 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2441 // is not used by anyone else...
2442 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002443 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002444 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002445 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2446 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2447 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2448 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002449
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002450 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002451 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002452 }
2453
2454 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2455 //
2456 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2457 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2458 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2459
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002460 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002461 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2462 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002463 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002464
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002465 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002466 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002467 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002468 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002469 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002470 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002471 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2472
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002473 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002474 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002475 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002476 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002477 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002478 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002479
2480 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2481 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2482 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2483 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2484 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2485 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002486 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002487 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002488 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002489 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002490 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002491 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002492
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002493 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002494 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002495 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002496 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2498 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2499 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002500 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2501 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002502 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002503 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002504 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002505
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002506 ConstantInt *C1;
2507 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002508 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002509 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002510
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002511 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2512 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002513 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002514 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002515 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002516}
2517
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002518/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2519/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2520/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2521/// signed.
2522static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2523 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002524 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2526 TrueIfSigned = true;
2527 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2529 TrueIfSigned = true;
2530 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2532 TrueIfSigned = false;
2533 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2535 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2536 TrueIfSigned = true;
2537 return RHS->getValue() ==
2538 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2540 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2541 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002542 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002543 default:
2544 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002545 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002546}
2547
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002548Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002549 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002550 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002551
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002552 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2553 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2554
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002555 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002556 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2557 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002558
2559 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002560 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002561 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2562 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002563 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002564 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002565
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002566 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002567 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2568 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2569 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2570 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002571 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002572
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002573 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002574 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002575 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002576 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002577 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002578 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002579 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2580 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002581
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002582 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2583 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002584 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2586 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2587 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2588 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2589
2590 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2591 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2592 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2593 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002595 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002596
2597 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2598 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002599 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002600 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002601 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002602 Op1, "tmp");
2603 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2604 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2605 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002606 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002607
2608 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002609
2610 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2611 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002612 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002613 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002614
2615 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2616 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2617 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002618 }
2619
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002620 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2621 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002622 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002623
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002624 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2625 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2626
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002627 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2628 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2629 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2630 // formed.
2631 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002632 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002633 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002634 BoolCast = CI;
2635 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002636 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002637 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002638 BoolCast = CI;
2639 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002640 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002641 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2642 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002643 bool TIS = false;
2644
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002645 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002646 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2647 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002648 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2649 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002650 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002651 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002652 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002653 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002654 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002655 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002656 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2657 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002658
2659 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2660 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002661 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002662 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2663 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002664 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2665 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2666 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2667 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2668 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002669
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002670 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002671 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002672 }
2673 }
2674 }
2675
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002676 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002677}
2678
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002679/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2680/// instruction.
2681bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2682 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2683
2684 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2685 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2686 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2687 if (ST->isNullValue())
2688 NonNullOperand = 2;
2689 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2690 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2691 if (ST->isNullValue())
2692 NonNullOperand = 1;
2693
2694 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2695 return false;
2696
2697 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2698
2699 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2700 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2701
2702 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2703 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2704 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2705 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2706 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2707
2708 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2709 // early exit.
2710 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2711 return true;
2712
2713 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2714 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2715
2716 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2717 --BBI;
2718 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2719 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2720 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2721 break;
2722
2723 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2724 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2725 I != E; ++I) {
2726 if (*I == SI) {
2727 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2728 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2729 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2730 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2731 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2732 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2733 }
2734 }
2735
2736 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2737 if (&*BBI == SI)
2738 SI = 0;
2739 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2740 SelectCond = 0;
2741
2742 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2743 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2744 break;
2745
2746 }
2747 return true;
2748}
2749
2750
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002751/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2752/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2753/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2754/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002755Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002756 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002757
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002758 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2759 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2760 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2761 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2762 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002763 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002764 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002765
2766 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002767 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002769
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002770 return 0;
2771}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002772
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002773/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2774/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2775/// division instructions.
2776/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002777Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002778 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2779
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002780 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002781 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2782 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2783 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2784 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2786 }
2787
2788 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2790 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002791
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002792 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2793 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002794
2795 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2796 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2797 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2798 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002799
2800 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2801 // div X, 1 == X
2802 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2803 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2804
2805 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2806 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2807 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2808 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002809 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2811 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002812 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002813 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002814 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002815
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002816 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002817 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2818 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2819 return R;
2820 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2821 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2822 return NV;
2823 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002824 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002825
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002826 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002827 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002828 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2830
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002831 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2832 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2834
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002835 return 0;
2836}
2837
2838Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2839 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2840
2841 // Handle the integer div common cases
2842 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2843 return Common;
2844
2845 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2846 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2847 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2848 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002849 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002850 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002851 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002852 }
2853
2854 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002855 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002856 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2857 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002858 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002859 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002860 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002861 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002862 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002863 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002864 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002865 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002866 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002867 }
2868 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002869 }
2870
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002871 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2872 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002873 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002874 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002875 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002876 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002877 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002878 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002879 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002880 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2881 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002882 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002883 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2884 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2885
2886 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2887 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002888 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002889 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2890 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002891
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002892 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002893 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002894 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002895 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002896 return 0;
2897}
2898
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002899Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2900 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2901
2902 // Handle the integer div common cases
2903 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2904 return Common;
2905
2906 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2907 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2908 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002909 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002910
2911 // -X/C -> X/-C
2912 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002913 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002914 }
2915
2916 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2917 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002918 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002919 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002920 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002921 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002922 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002923 }
2924 }
2925
2926 return 0;
2927}
2928
2929Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2930 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2931}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002932
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002933/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2934/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2935/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2936/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2937Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002938 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002939
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002940 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002941 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2942 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2943 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2944
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002945 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2946 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002949 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002950 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002952
2953 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002954 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2955 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002956
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002957 return 0;
2958}
2959
2960/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2961/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2962/// remainder instructions.
2963/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2964Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2965 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2966
2967 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2968 return common;
2969
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002970 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002971 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2972 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2973 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2974
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002975 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2977
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002978 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2979 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2980 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2981 return R;
2982 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2983 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2984 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002985 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002986
2987 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2988 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2989 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2990 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2991 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2992 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002993 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002994 }
2995
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002996 return 0;
2997}
2998
2999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3000 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3001
3002 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3003 return common;
3004
3005 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3006 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3007 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3008 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3009 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003010 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003011 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003012 }
3013
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003014 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003015 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3016 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3017 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003018 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003019 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003020 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003021 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003022 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003023 }
3024 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003025 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003026
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003027 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3028 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3029 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3030 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3031 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3032 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003033 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3034 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003035 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003036 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003037 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003038 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003039 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003040 }
3041 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003042 }
3043
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003044 return 0;
3045}
3046
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003047Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3048 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3049
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003050 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003051 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3052 return common;
3053
3054 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003055 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3056 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3057 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003058 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3059 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3060 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3061 return &I;
3062 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003063
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003064 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003065 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003066 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3067 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3068 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3069 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003070 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003071 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003072 }
3073
3074 return 0;
3075}
3076
3077Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003078 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3079}
3080
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003081// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3082// constant.
3083static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003084 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003085}
3086
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003087// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3088// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3089static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003090 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003091}
3092
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003093/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003094/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3095///
3096/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3097///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003098/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3099/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003100///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003101/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3102/// 0 A > B
3103/// 1 A == B
3104/// 2 A < B
3105///
3106/// <=> Value Definition
3107/// 000 0 Always false
3108/// 001 1 A > B
3109/// 010 2 A == B
3110/// 011 3 A >= B
3111/// 100 4 A < B
3112/// 101 5 A != B
3113/// 110 6 A <= B
3114/// 111 7 Always true
3115///
3116static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3117 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003118 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003119 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3120 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3122 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3124 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3125 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3126 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3127 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3128 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003129 // True -> 7
3130 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003131 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003132 return 0;
3133 }
3134}
3135
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003136/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3137/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3138/// predicate by reference.
3139static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3140 isOrdered = false;
3141 switch (CC) {
3142 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3143 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003144 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3145 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3146 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3147 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003148 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3149 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3150 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3151 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003152 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3153 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003154 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3155 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003156 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003157 default:
3158 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3159 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3160 return 0;
3161 }
3162}
3163
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003164/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3165/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003166/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003167/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003168static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3169 switch (code) {
3170 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003171 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003172 case 1:
3173 if (sign)
3174 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3175 else
3176 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3177 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3178 case 3:
3179 if (sign)
3180 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3181 else
3182 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3183 case 4:
3184 if (sign)
3185 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3186 else
3187 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3188 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3189 case 6:
3190 if (sign)
3191 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3192 else
3193 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003194 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003195 }
3196}
3197
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003198/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3199/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3200/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3201static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3202 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3203 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003204 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003205 case 0:
3206 if (isordered)
3207 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3208 else
3209 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3210 case 1:
3211 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003212 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3213 else
3214 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003215 case 2:
3216 if (isordered)
3217 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3218 else
3219 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003220 case 3:
3221 if (isordered)
3222 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3223 else
3224 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3225 case 4:
3226 if (isordered)
3227 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3228 else
3229 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3230 case 5:
3231 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003232 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3233 else
3234 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3235 case 6:
3236 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003237 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3238 else
3239 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003240 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003241 }
3242}
3243
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003244/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3245/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003246static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3247 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003248 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3249 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003250}
3251
3252namespace {
3253// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3254struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003255 InstCombiner &IC;
3256 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003257 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3258 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3259 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3260 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003261 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003262 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3263 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003264 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3265 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003266 return false;
3267 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003268 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3269 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3270 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3271 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3272 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003273 }
3274
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003275 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003276 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003277 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003278 unsigned Code;
3279 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3280 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3281 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3282 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003283 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003284 }
3285
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003286 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3287 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3288
3289 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003290 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3291 return I;
3292 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3293 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3294 }
3295};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003296} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003297
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003298// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3299// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003300// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003301Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003302 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3303 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003304 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3305 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003306 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003307 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003308 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003309
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003310 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3311 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003312 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003313 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003314 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003315 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003316 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003317 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003318 }
3319 break;
3320 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003321 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3322 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003323
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003324 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3325 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003326 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003327 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003328 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003329 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003330 }
3331 break;
3332 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003333 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003334 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3335 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3336 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003337 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003338
3339 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003340 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003341 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3342 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3343 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003344 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003345
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003346 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3347 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3348 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3349 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3350 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3351 // no effect.
3352 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3353 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3354 return &TheAnd;
3355 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003356 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003357 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003358 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003359 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003360 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003361 }
3362 }
3363 }
3364 }
3365 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003366
3367 case Instruction::Shl: {
3368 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3369 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3370 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003371 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003372 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003373 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3374 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003375
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003376 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3377 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3379 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003380 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3381 return &TheAnd;
3382 }
3383 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003384 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003385 case Instruction::LShr:
3386 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003387 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3388 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3389 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3390 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003391 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003392 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003393 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3394 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003395
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003396 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3397 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3399 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3400 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3401 return &TheAnd;
3402 }
3403 break;
3404 }
3405 case Instruction::AShr:
3406 // Signed shr.
3407 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3408 // with an and.
3409 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003410 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003411 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003412 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3413 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003414 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003415 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003416 // Make the argument unsigned.
3417 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003418 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003419 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003420 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003421 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003422 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003423 }
3424 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003425 }
3426 return 0;
3427}
3428
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003429
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003430/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3431/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003432/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3433/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003434/// insert new instructions.
3435Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003436 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3437 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003438 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003439 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003440 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003441
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003442 if (Inside) {
3443 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003444 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003445
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003446 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003447 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003448 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003449 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3450 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3451 }
3452
3453 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3454 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003455 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003456 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003457 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3458 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003459 }
3460
3461 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003462 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003463
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003464 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003465 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003466 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003467 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3468 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3469 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3470 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003471
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003472 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3473 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3474 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003475 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003476 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003477 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3478 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003479}
3480
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003481// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3482// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3483// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3484// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003485static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003486 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003487 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3488 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003489
3490 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003491 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003492 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003493 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003494 return true;
3495}
3496
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003497/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3498/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3499/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003500///
3501/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3502/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3503/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3504///
3505/// return (A +/- B).
3506///
3507Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003508 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003509 Instruction &I) {
3510 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3511 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3512 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3513
3514 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3515
3516 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3517 default: return 0;
3518 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003519 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003520 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003521 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3522 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3523 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003524 break;
3525
3526 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3527 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3528 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003529 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003530 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003531 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003532 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003533 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003534 break;
3535 }
3536 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003537 return 0;
3538 case Instruction::Or:
3539 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003540 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003541 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3542 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003543 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003544 break;
3545 return 0;
3546 }
3547
3548 Instruction *New;
3549 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003550 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003551 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003552 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003553 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3554}
3555
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003556/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3557Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3558 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
3559 Value *Val;
3560 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3561 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3562
3563 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3564 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
3565 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Specific(Val), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3566 return 0;
3567
3568 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3569 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3570 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3571 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3572 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3573 return 0;
3574
3575 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3576 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3577 return 0;
3578
3579 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
3580 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3581 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3582 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3583 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3584 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3585 else
3586 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3587
3588 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3589 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
3590 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3591 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3592 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3593 }
3594
3595 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3596 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3597 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3598 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3599 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3600 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3601 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3602
3603 switch (LHSCC) {
3604 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3605 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3606 switch (RHSCC) {
3607 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3608 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3609 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3610 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3611 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3613 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3614 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3616 }
3617 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3618 switch (RHSCC) {
3619 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3621 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3622 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
3623 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3624 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3625 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3626 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
3627 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3633 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3634 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3635 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
3636 Val->getName()+".off");
3637 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
3638 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3639 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
3640 }
3641 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3642 }
3643 break;
3644 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3645 switch (RHSCC) {
3646 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3647 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3648 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
3649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3650 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3651 break;
3652 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3653 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3655 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3656 break;
3657 }
3658 break;
3659 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3660 switch (RHSCC) {
3661 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3662 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3663 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
3664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3666 break;
3667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3669 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3670 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3671 break;
3672 }
3673 break;
3674 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3675 switch (RHSCC) {
3676 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3678 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3681 break;
3682 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3683 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3684 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3685 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3686 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3687 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false, true, I);
3688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3689 break;
3690 }
3691 break;
3692 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3693 switch (RHSCC) {
3694 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3695 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3696 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3698 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3699 break;
3700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3701 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3702 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3703 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3705 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true, true, I);
3706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3707 break;
3708 }
3709 break;
3710 }
3711
3712
3713
3714 return 0;
3715}
3716
3717
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003718Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003719 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003720 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003721
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003722 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3724
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003725 // and X, X = X
3726 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003728
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003729 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003730 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003731 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003732 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3733 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3734 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003735 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003736 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003737 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003738 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003739 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003740 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003741 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003743 }
3744 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003745
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003746 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003747 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3748 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003749
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003750 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003751 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003752 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003753 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3754 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3755 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3756 case Instruction::Xor:
3757 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003758 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3759 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3760 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3761 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003762 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003763 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3764 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003765 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003766 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003767 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003768 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003769 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3770 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003771 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003772 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3773 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003774 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003775 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3776 }
3777 }
3778
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003779 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003780 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003781 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3782 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3783 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3784 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003785 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003786 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003787 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003788 break;
3789
3790 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003791 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3792 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3793 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3794 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003795 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003796
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003797 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3798 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3799 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3800 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3801 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3802 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3803
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003804 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003805 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3806 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003807 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3808 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3809 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3810 }
3811 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003812 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003813
3814 case Instruction::Shl:
3815 case Instruction::LShr:
3816 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3817 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003818 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003819 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3820 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3821 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3822 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3823 }
3824 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003825 }
3826
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003827 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003828 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003829 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003830 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003831 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3832 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3833 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3834 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003835 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003836 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003837 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003838 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3839 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003840 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3841 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3842 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003843 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003844 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3845 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003846 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003847 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003848 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003849 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003850 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003851 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3852 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3853 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003854 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003855 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3857 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003858 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003859 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003860 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003861
3862 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3863 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003864 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003865 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003866 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3867 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3868 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003869 }
3870
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003871 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3872 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003873
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003874 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3876
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003877 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003878 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003879 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003880 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003881 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003882 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003883 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003884
3885 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003886 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3887 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003888 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003890
3891 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3892 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3893 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003894 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003895 }
3896 }
3897
3898 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003899 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003901
3902 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3903 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3904 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003905 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003906 }
3907 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003908
3909 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3910 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3911 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3912 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3913 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3914 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3915 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3916 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3917 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3918 }
3919 }
3920 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3921 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3922 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3923 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3924 std::swap(A, B);
3925 }
3926 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003927 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003928 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003929 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003930 }
3931 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003932 }
3933
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003934 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3935 // where C is a power of 2
3936 Value *A, *B;
3937 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003938 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3939 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003940 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3941 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3942 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3943 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3944 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3945 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3946 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3947 }
3948 }
3949
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003950 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3951 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3952 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003953 return R;
3954
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003955 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
3956 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
3957 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003958 }
3959
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003960 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003961 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3962 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3963 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3964 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003965 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003966 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003967 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3968 I.getType(), TD) &&
3969 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3970 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003971 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003972 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3973 I.getName());
3974 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003975 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003976 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003977 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003978
3979 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003980 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3981 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3982 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003983 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3984 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3985 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003986 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003987 SI1->getOperand(0),
3988 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003989 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003990 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003991 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003992 }
3993
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003994 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003995 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3996 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3997 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003998 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3999 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004000 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4001 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4002 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4003 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004004 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4006 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
4007 RHS->getOperand(0));
4008 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004009 } else {
4010 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4011 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4012 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4013 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00004014 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4015 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4016 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4017 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4018 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004019 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4020 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4021 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4022 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4023 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4024 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4026 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4027 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4028 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4030 bool Op0Ordered;
4031 bool Op1Ordered;
4032 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4033 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4034 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4035 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4036 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4037 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4038 }
4039 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4040 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4041 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4042 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4043 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4044 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4045 // uno && ord -> false
4046 if (!Op0Ordered)
4047 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4048 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4049 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4050 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4051 }
4052 }
4053 }
4054 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004055 }
4056 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004057
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004058 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004059}
4060
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004061/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4062/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4063/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4064/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4065/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4066/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4067/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4068/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4069/// match.
4070///
4071/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4072/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4073/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4074/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4075/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4076/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4077///
4078/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4079/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4080/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4081/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4082/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4083///
4084static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4085 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4086 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4087 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4088 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4089 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4090 ByteValues) ||
4091 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4092 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004093 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004094
4095 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4096 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4097 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4098 unsigned ShAmt =
4099 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4100 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4101 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4102 return true;
4103
4104 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4105 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4106 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4107 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4108 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4109 } else {
4110 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4111 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4112 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004113 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004114 }
4115
4116 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4117 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4118
4119 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4120 ByteValues);
4121 }
4122
4123 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4124 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4125 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4126 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4127 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4128 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4129 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4130 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4131
4132 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4133 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4134 // the and mask is.
4135 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4136 continue;
4137
4138 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4139 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4140 if (MaskB == 0) {
4141 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4142 continue;
4143 }
4144
4145 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4146 if (MaskB != Byte)
4147 return true;
4148
4149 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4150 }
4151
4152 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4153 ByteValues);
4154 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004155 }
4156
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004157 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4158 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4159 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4160 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4161 // their ultimate destination.
4162 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4163 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004164
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004165 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4166 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4167 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4168 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4169 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4170 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4171 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4172 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4173 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4174 return true;
4175 } else {
4176 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4177 return true;
4178 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004179
4180 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4181 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004182 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004183 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004184 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004185 return false;
4186}
4187
4188/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4189/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4190Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004191 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004192 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4193 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4194 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004195 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004196
4197 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4198 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004199 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004200 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004201
4202 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004203 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4204 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004205 return 0;
4206
4207 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4208 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4209 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4210
4211 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4212 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4213 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4214 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004215 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004216 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004217 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004218 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004219}
4220
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004221/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4222/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4223/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4224static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
4225 Value *C, Value *D) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004226 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004227 Value *Cond = 0;
Chris Lattner321e6a62008-11-16 04:33:38 +00004228 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst(m_Value(Cond), -1, 0)))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004229 return 0;
4230
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004231 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004232 if (match(D, m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), 0, -1)))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004233 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004234 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), -1, 0))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004235 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4236 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004237 if (match(B, m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), 0, -1)))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004238 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004239 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), -1, 0))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004240 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004241 return 0;
4242}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004243
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004244Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004245 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004246 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004247
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004248 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004250
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004251 // or X, X = X
4252 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004254
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004255 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4256 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004257 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4258 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4259 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4260 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4261 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4262 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004263 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4265 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4266 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004268 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004269
4270
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004271
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004272 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004273 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004274 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004275 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4276 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004277 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004278 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004279 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004280 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004281 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004282 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004283
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004284 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4285 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004286 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004287 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004288 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004289 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004290 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004291 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004292
4293 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4294 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004295 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004296 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004297 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4298 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4299 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004300 }
4301
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004302 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4303 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004304
4305 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4306 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4308 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4309 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4311
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004312 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4313 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004314 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004315 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4316 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4317 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004318 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4319 return BSwap;
4320 }
4321
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004322 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4323 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004324 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004325 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004326 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4327 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004328 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004329 }
4330
4331 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4332 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004333 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004334 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004335 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4336 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004337 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004338 }
4339
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004340 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004341 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004342 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4343 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004344 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4345 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4346 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4347 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4348 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4349 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4350 // replace with V+N.
4351 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4352 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4353 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4354 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4355 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4356 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4357 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4359 }
4360 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4361 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4362 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4363 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4364 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4366 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4368 }
4369 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004370 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004371 }
4372
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004373 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4374 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004375 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4376 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4377 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4378 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4379 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4380 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4381 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4382 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4383 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4384
4385 if (V1) {
4386 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004387 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4388 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004389 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004390 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004391
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004392 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004393 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D))
4394 return Match;
4395 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C))
4396 return Match;
4397 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D))
4398 return Match;
4399 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C))
4400 return Match;
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004401 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004402
4403 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004404 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4405 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4406 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004407 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4408 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4409 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004410 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004411 SI1->getOperand(0),
4412 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004413 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004414 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004415 }
4416 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004417
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004418 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4419 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004420 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004421 } else {
4422 A = 0;
4423 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004424 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004425 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4426 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004427 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004428
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004429 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004430 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004431 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004432 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004433 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004434 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004435 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004436
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004437 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4438 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4439 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004440 return R;
4441
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004442 Value *Val;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004443 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004444 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004445 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4446 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) &&
4447 match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Specific(Val), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))) &&
4448
4449 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4450 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4451 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4452 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4453 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4454
4455 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4456 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
4457 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4458 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
4459 bool NeedsSwap;
4460 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4461 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
4462 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4463 else
4464 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4465
4466 if (NeedsSwap) {
4467 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4468 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4469 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4470 }
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004471
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004472 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4473 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4474 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4475 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4476 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4477 // equal.
4478 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004479
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004480 switch (LHSCC) {
4481 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4482 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4483 switch (RHSCC) {
4484 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4485 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4486 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) { // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4487 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
4488 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
4489 Val->getName()+".off");
4490 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
4491 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
4492 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004493 }
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004494 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4495 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4497 break;
4498 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4499 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4500 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004502 }
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004503 break;
4504 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4505 switch (RHSCC) {
4506 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4507 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4509 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4510 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4512 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4513 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4515 }
4516 break;
4517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4518 switch (RHSCC) {
4519 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4521 break;
4522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4523 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4524 // this can cause overflow.
4525 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4526 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4527 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false, false, I);
4528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4529 break;
4530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4534 break;
4535 }
4536 break;
4537 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4538 switch (RHSCC) {
4539 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4541 break;
4542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4543 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4544 // this can cause overflow.
4545 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4546 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4547 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true, false, I);
4548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4549 break;
4550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4554 break;
4555 }
4556 break;
4557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4558 switch (RHSCC) {
4559 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4564 break;
4565 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4567 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4569 break;
4570 }
4571 break;
4572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4573 switch (RHSCC) {
4574 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4579 break;
4580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4581 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4583 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4584 break;
4585 }
4586 break;
4587 }
4588 }
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004589 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004590
4591 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004592 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004593 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004594 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004595 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4596 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4597 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4598 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4599 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4600 // generated.
4601 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4602 I.getType(), TD) &&
4603 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4604 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004605 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004606 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4607 I.getName());
4608 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004609 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004610 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004611 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004612 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004613 }
4614
4615
4616 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4617 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4618 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4619 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004620 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004621 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004622 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4623 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4624 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4625 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004626 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4628
4629 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4630 // rest.
4631 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4632 RHS->getOperand(0));
4633 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004634 } else {
4635 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4636 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4637 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4638 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4639 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4640 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4641 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4642 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4643 }
4644 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4645 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4646 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4647 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4648 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4649 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4650 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4651 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4652 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4653 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4655 bool Op0Ordered;
4656 bool Op1Ordered;
4657 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4658 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4659 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4660 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4661 // or'ed predicates.
4662 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4663 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4664 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4665 return I;
4666 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4668 }
4669 }
4670 }
4671 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004672 }
4673 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004674
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004675 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004676}
4677
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004678namespace {
4679
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004680// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4681struct XorSelf {
4682 Value *RHS;
4683 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4684 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4685 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4686 return &Xor;
4687 }
4688};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004689
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004690}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004691
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004692Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004693 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004694 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004695
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004696 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4697 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4698 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4699 // idiom (misuse).
4700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004701 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004702 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004703
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004704 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4705 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004706 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004708 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004709
4710 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4711 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004712 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4713 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4714 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4715 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4716 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4717 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004718 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4719 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004720 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004721
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004722 // Is this a ~ operation?
4723 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4724 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4725 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4726 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4727 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4728 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4729 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4730 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4731 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004732 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004733 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4734 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4735 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004736 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004737 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004738 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004739 }
4740 }
4741 }
4742 }
4743
4744
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004745 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004746 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4747 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4748 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004749 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4750 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004751
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004752 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4753 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4754 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4755 }
4756
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004757 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4758 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4759 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4760 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4761 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4762 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4763 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4764 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4765 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4766 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4767 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4768 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4769 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4770 }
4771 }
4772 }
4773 }
4774 }
4775
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004776 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004777 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004778 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4779 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004780 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4781 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004782 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004783 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004784 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004785
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004786 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004787 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004788 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004789 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004790 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004791 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004792 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004793 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004794 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004795 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004796 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4797 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004798 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004799
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004800 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004801 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4802 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004803 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004804 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4805 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4806 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004807 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004808 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4809 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004810 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004811 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4812 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4813 return &I;
4814 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004815 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004816 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004817 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004818
4819 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4820 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004821 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004822 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004823 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4824 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4825 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004826 }
4827
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004828 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004829 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004831
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004832 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004833 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004835
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004836
4837 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4838 if (Op1I) {
4839 Value *A, *B;
4840 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4841 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004842 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004843 I.swapOperands();
4844 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004845 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004846 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004847 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004848 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004849 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4850 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4852 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4853 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4854 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004855 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004856 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004857 std::swap(A, B);
4858 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004859 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004860 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4861 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4862 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004863 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004864 }
4865
4866 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4867 if (Op0I) {
4868 Value *A, *B;
4869 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4870 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4871 std::swap(A, B);
4872 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4873 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004874 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4875 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004876 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004877 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4878 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4880 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4881 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4882 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4883 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4884 std::swap(A, B);
4885 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004886 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004887 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004888 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4889 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004890 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004891 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004892 }
4893
4894 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4895 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4896 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4897 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4898 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4899 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004900 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004901 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4902 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004903 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004904 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4905 }
4906
4907 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4908 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4909 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4910 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4911 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4912 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004913 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004914 }
4915 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4916 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4917 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4918 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004919 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004920 }
4921
4922 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4923 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4924 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4925 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4926 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4927 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4928 if (A == C)
4929 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4930 else if (A == D)
4931 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4932 else if (B == C)
4933 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4934 else if (B == D)
4935 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4936
4937 if (X) {
4938 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004939 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4940 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004941 }
4942 }
4943 }
4944
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004945 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4946 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4947 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004948 return R;
4949
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004950 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004951 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004952 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004953 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4954 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004955 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004956 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004957 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4958 I.getType(), TD) &&
4959 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4960 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004961 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004962 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4963 I.getName());
4964 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004965 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004966 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004967 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004968 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004969
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004970 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004971}
4972
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004973/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4974/// overflowed for this type.
4975static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004976 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004977 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004978
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004979 if (IsSigned)
4980 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4981 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4982 else
4983 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4984 else
4985 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004986}
4987
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004988/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4989/// overflowed for this type.
4990static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4991 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00004992 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004993
4994 if (IsSigned)
4995 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4996 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4997 else
4998 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4999 else
5000 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5001}
5002
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005003/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5004/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5005/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5006static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
5007 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5008 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005009 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5010 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005011
5012 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005013 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005014 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005015
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005016 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5017 ++i, ++GTI) {
5018 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00005019 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005020 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5021 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5022
5023 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5024 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5025 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5026
5027 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
5028 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005029 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005030 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005031 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005032 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5033 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5034 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005035 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005036
5037 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5038 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5039 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
5040 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5041 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5042 else {
5043 // Emit an add instruction.
5044 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005045 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005046 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005047 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005048 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005049 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005050 // Convert to correct type.
5051 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5052 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5053 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5054 else
5055 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5056 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5057 }
5058 if (Size != 1) {
5059 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5060 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5061 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5062 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005063 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005064 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5065 }
5066
5067 // Emit an add instruction.
5068 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5069 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5070 cast<Constant>(Result));
5071 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005072 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005073 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005074 }
5075 return Result;
5076}
5077
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005078
5079/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5080/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5081/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5082/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5083/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5084/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5085/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5086///
5087/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5088///
5089static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5090 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005091 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5092 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5093
5094 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5095 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5096 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5097 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5098 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5099 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5100 int64_t Offset = 0;
5101 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5102 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5103 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5104 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5105
5106 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5107 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5108 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5109 } else {
5110 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5111 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5112 }
5113 } else {
5114 // Found our variable index.
5115 break;
5116 }
5117 }
5118
5119 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5120 // evaluate it the general way.
5121 if (i == e) return 0;
5122
5123 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5124 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5125 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5126 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5127
5128 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5129 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5130 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5131 if (!CI) return 0;
5132
5133 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5134 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5135
5136 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5137 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5138 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5139 } else {
5140 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5141 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5142 }
5143 }
5144
5145 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5146 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5147 // the index.
5148 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5149 if (Offset == 0) {
5150 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5151 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5152 // computation crosses zero.
5153 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5154 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5155 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5156 return VariableIdx;
5157 }
5158
5159 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5160 // the pointer size, so get it.
5161 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5162
5163 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5164 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5165
5166 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5167 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5168 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5169 // multiple of the variable scale.
5170 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5171 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5172 return 0;
5173
5174 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5175 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5176 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005177 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005178 true /*SExt*/,
5179 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5180 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005181 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005182}
5183
5184
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005185/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005186/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005187Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5188 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5189 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005190 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005191
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005192 // Look through bitcasts.
5193 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5194 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005195
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005196 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5197 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005198 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005199 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5200 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5201 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5202
5203 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5204 if (Offset == 0)
5205 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005206 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5207 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005208 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005209 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5210 // compare the base pointer.
5211 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5212 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005213 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005214 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005215 if (IndicesTheSame)
5216 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5217 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5218 IndicesTheSame = false;
5219 break;
5220 }
5221
5222 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5223 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005224 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5225 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005226
5227 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5228 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005229 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005230 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005231
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005232 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5233 bool AllZeros = true;
5234 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5235 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5236 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5237 AllZeros = false;
5238 break;
5239 }
5240 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005241 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5242 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005243
5244 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005245 AllZeros = true;
5246 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5247 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5248 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5249 AllZeros = false;
5250 break;
5251 }
5252 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005253 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005254
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005255 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5256 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5257 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5258 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5259 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5260 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005261 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5262 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005263 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005264 NumDifferences = 2;
5265 break;
5266 } else {
5267 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5268 DiffOperand = i;
5269 }
5270 }
5271
5272 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005274 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005275 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005276
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005277 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005278 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5279 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005280 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5281 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005282 }
5283 }
5284
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005285 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005286 // the result to fold to a constant!
5287 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5288 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5289 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5290 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5291 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005292 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005293 }
5294 }
5295 return 0;
5296}
5297
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005298/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5299///
5300Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5301 Instruction *LHSI,
5302 Constant *RHSC) {
5303 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5304 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5305
5306 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5307 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005308 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005309 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5310
5311 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5312 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5313 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5314 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5315
5316 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005317 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5318 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005319 ++InputSize;
5320
5321 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5322 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5323 return 0;
5324
5325 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5326 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5327 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5328 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5329
5330 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5331 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5332 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5333 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005334 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5335 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5336 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005337 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005338 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5339 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5340 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005341 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005342 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5343 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5344 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005345 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005346 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5347 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5348 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005349 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005350 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5351 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5352 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005353 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005354 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5355 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5356 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005357 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5359 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5361 }
5362
5363 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5364
5365 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5366
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005367 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005368 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5369 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5370
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005371 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5372 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5373 // and large values.
5374 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5375 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5376 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5377 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5378 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5379 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
5380 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5381 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5382 }
5383 } else {
5384 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5385 // +INF and large values.
5386 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5387 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5388 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5389 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5390 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5391 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
5392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5394 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005395 }
5396
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005397 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5398 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5399 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5400 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5401 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5402 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5403 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5404 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
5405 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5407 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005408 }
5409
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005410 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5411 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5412 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5413 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005414 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5415 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5416 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005417 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust the
5418 // compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards zero
5419 // at this point.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005420 switch (Pred) {
5421 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5422 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5423 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5424 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5425 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005426 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5427 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5428 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5429 if (RHS.isNegative())
5430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5431 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005432 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5433 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5434 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5435 if (RHS.isNegative())
5436 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5437 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5439 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5440 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5441 if (RHS.isNegative())
5442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5443 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5444 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005445 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5446 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5447 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5448 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5449 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5450 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005451 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5452 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5453 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5454 if (RHS.isNegative())
5455 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5456 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005457 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5458 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5459 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5460 if (RHS.isNegative())
5461 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5462 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005463 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5464 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5465 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5466 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5468 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5469 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005470 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5471 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5472 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5473 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5474 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5475 break;
5476 }
5477 }
5478
5479 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5480 // comparison.
5481 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5482}
5483
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005484Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5485 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005486 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005487
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005488 // Fold trivial predicates.
5489 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5490 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5491 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5492 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5493
5494 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5495 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5496 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5497 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5498 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5499 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5500 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5502 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5503 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5504 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5505 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5506
5507 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5508 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5509 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5510 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5511 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5512 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5513 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5514 return &I;
5515
5516 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5517 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5518 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5519 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5520 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5521 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5522 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5523 return &I;
5524 }
5525 }
5526
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005527 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005529
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005530 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5531 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005532 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5533 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5534 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5535 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005537 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5538 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5539 // True if unordered.
5540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005541 }
5542 }
5543
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005544 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5545 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5546 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005547 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5548 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5549 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5550 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5551 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5552 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005553 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005554 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5555 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5556 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5557 return NV;
5558 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005559 case Instruction::Select:
5560 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5561 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5562 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5563 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5564 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5565 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5566 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5567 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5568 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5569 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5570 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5571 I.getName()), I);
5572 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5573 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5574 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5575 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5576 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5577 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5578 I.getName()), I);
5579 }
5580 }
5581
5582 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005583 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005584 break;
5585 }
5586 }
5587
5588 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5589}
5590
5591Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5592 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5593 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5594 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5595
5596 // icmp X, X
5597 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005598 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005599 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005600
5601 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005603
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005604 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005605 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005606 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5607 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5608 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005609 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005611 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005612
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005613 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005614 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005615 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5616 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005617 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005618 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005619 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005620 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005621 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005622 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005623 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005624
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005625 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005626 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005627 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005629 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005630 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005631 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005632 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5634 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005635 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005636 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5637 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5638 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5639 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5640 }
5641 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5642 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5643 // FALL THROUGH
5644 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005645 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005646 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005647 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005648 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005649 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5650 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5651 // FALL THROUGH
5652 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5653 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5654 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5655 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5656 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005657 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005658 }
5659
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005660 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005661 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005662 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005663
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005664 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5665 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5666 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5667 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5668 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005669 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005670
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005671 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5672 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5673 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005674 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5675 default: break;
5676 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5677 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5679 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5681 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5683 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5684 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5685 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5687 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5689 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5691 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5692 }
5693
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005694 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5695 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5696 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5697 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5698
5699 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005700 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005701 bool UnusedBit;
5702 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5703
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005704 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5705 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5706 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005707 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5708 return &I;
5709
5710 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005711 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5712 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5713 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005714 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5715 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5716 else
5717 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5718
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005719 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5720 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5721 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5722 if (Min == Max)
5723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5724 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5725 CI));
5726
5727 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5728 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5729 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005730 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5731 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5732 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5733 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5735 break;
5736 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5737 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5738 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5739 break;
5740 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005741 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005743 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005745 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5746 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5747 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5748 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5749
5750 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5751 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5752 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5753 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005754 break;
5755 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005756 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005758 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005759 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005760
5761 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5762 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5763 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5764 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5765
5766 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5767 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5768 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5769 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005770 break;
5771 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005772 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005774 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005776 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5777 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005778 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005779 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005780 break;
5781 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005782 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005784 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005786
5787 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5788 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5789 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5790 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005791 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005792 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005793 }
5794
5795 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5796 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5797 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5798 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5799 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5800 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5801 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5802 if (I.hasOneUse())
5803 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5804 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5805 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5806 return 0;
5807
5808 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5809 // can be folded into the comparison.
5810 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005811 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005812 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005813 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005814 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005815 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5816 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005817 }
5818
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005819 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005820 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5821 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5822 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005823 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5824 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005825 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005826 bool isAllZeros = true;
5827 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5828 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5829 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5830 isAllZeros = false;
5831 break;
5832 }
5833 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005834 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005835 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5836 }
5837 break;
5838
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005839 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005840 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5841 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5842 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5843 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5844 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5845 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005846 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005847 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005848 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5849 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5850 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5851 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5852 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5853 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5854 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005855 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5856 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5857 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5858 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5859 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005860 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5861 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005862 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5863 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5864 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5865 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5866 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005867 }
5868 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005869
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005870 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005871 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005872 break;
5873 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005874 case Instruction::Malloc:
5875 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5876 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5877 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5878 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005880 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005881 }
5882 break;
5883 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005884 }
5885
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005886 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005887 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005888 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005889 return NI;
5890 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005891 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5892 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005893 return NI;
5894
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005895 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005896 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5897 // now.
5898 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5899 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5900 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005901 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5902 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005903 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005904
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005905 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5906 // so eliminate it as well.
5907 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5908 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005909
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005910 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005911 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005912 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005913 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005914 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005915 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005916 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005917 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005918 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005919 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005920 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005921 }
5922
5923 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005924 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005925 // This comes up when you have code like
5926 // int X = A < B;
5927 // if (X) ...
5928 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005929 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5930 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005931 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005932 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005933 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005934
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005935 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5936 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5937 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005938 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5939 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5940 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005941 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005942 default: break;
5943 case Instruction::Add:
5944 case Instruction::Sub:
5945 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005946 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5947 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5948 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005949 break;
5950 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005951 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5952 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5953 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5954 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5955 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5956 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5957 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5958 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005959 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005960 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5961 Mask);
5962 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5963 Mask);
5964 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5965 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5966 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005967 }
5968 }
5969 break;
5970 }
5971 }
5972 }
5973 }
5974
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005975 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5976 { Value *A, *B;
5977 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5978 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5979 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5980 }
5981
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005982 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005983 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005984
5985 // -x == -y --> x == y
5986 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5987 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5988 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5989
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005990 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5991 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5992 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5993 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5994 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5995 }
5996
5997 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5998 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5999 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
6000 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
6001 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006002 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006003 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006004 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
6005 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
6006 }
6007
6008 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
6009 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6010 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6011 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6012 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
6013 }
6014 }
6015
6016 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6017 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006018 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6019 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006020 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6021 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006022 }
6023 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006024 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006025 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6026 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006027 }
6028 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006029 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006030 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6031 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006032 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006033
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006034 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6035 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
6036 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6037 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6038 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6039
6040 if (A == C) {
6041 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6042 } else if (A == D) {
6043 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6044 } else if (B == C) {
6045 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6046 } else if (B == D) {
6047 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6048 }
6049
6050 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006051 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6052 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006053 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
6054 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
6055 return &I;
6056 }
6057 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006058 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006059 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006060}
6061
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006062
6063/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6064/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6065Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6066 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6067 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6068 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6069
6070 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6071 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6072 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6073 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6074 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6075 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6076 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6077 // if it finds it.
6078 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6079 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6080 return 0;
6081 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006082 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006083 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6084 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6085 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6086 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6087 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006088
6089 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6090 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6091 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6092 // instead of computing a divide.
6093 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
6094
6095 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6096 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6097 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6098 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6099 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6100
6101 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006102 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006103
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006104 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6105 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6106 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6107 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6108 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6109 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6110 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6111 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6112 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6113
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006114 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006115 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006116 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006117 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6118 if (!HiOverflow)
6119 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006120 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006121 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006122 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006123 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6124 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006125 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006126 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6127 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6128 if (!HiOverflow)
6129 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006130 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006131 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006132 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006133 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6134 if (!LoOverflow) {
6135 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6136 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6137 true) ? -1 : 0;
6138 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006139 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006140 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006141 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006142 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006143 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6144 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006145 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6146 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6147 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6148 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006149 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006150 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006151 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006152 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006153 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006154 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006155 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006156 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6157 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006158 if (!HiOverflow)
6159 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006160 }
6161
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006162 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6163 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006164 }
6165
6166 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006167 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006168 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6170 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6172 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006173 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006174 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6175 else if (LoOverflow)
6176 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6177 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6178 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006179 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006180 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6181 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6183 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006184 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006185 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6186 else if (LoOverflow)
6187 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6188 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6189 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006190 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006191 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6192 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006193 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6195 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006196 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006197 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006198 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6199 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006200 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006202 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6203 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6204 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006205 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6206 else
6207 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6208 }
6209}
6210
6211
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006212/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6213///
6214Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6215 Instruction *LHSI,
6216 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6217 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6218
6219 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006220 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006221 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6222 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6223 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006224 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6225 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006226 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6227
6228 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6229 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6230 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6231 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6232 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6233 return &ICI;
6234 }
6235
6236 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6237 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6238
6239 // If so, the new one isn't.
6240 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6241
6242 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6243 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6244 else
6245 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6246 }
6247 }
6248 break;
6249 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6250 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6251 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6252 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6253
6254 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6255 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6256 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6257 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6258 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6259 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6260 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6261 // bit would not work.
6262 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006263 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6264 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006265 uint32_t BitWidth =
6266 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6267 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6268 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6269 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6270 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6271 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006272 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006273 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6274 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6275 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6276 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6277 }
6278 }
6279
6280 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6281 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6282 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6283 // access.
6284 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6285 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6286 Shift = 0;
6287
6288 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6289 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6290 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6291 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6292
6293 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6294 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6295 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6296 if (ShAmt) {
6297 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6298 if (!CanFold) {
6299 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6300 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6301 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6302 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6303
6304 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6305 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6306 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6307 CanFold = true;
6308 }
6309
6310 if (CanFold) {
6311 Constant *NewCst;
6312 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6313 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6314 else
6315 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6316
6317 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6318 // compared.
6319 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6320 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6321 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6322 // result is always true or false now.
6323 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6325 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6326 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6327 } else {
6328 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6329 Constant *NewAndCST;
6330 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6331 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6332 else
6333 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6334 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6335 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6336 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6337 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6338 return &ICI;
6339 }
6340 }
6341 }
6342
6343 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6344 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6345 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6346 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6347 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6348 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6349 // Compute C << Y.
6350 Value *NS;
6351 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006352 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006353 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6354 } else {
6355 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006356 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006357 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6358 }
6359 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6360
6361 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6362 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006363 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006364 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6365
6366 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6367 return &ICI;
6368 }
6369 }
6370 break;
6371
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006372 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6373 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6374 if (!ShAmt) break;
6375
6376 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6377
6378 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6379 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6380 // simplified.
6381 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6382 break;
6383
6384 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6385 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6386 // comparison cannot succeed.
6387 Constant *Comp =
6388 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6389 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6390 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6391 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6393 }
6394
6395 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6396 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6397 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6398 Constant *Mask =
6399 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006400
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006401 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006402 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006403 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6404 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6405 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6406 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006407 }
6408 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006409
6410 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6411 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6412 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6413 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6414 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6415 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6416 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6417 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006418 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006419 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6420 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6421
6422 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6423 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6424 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006425 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006426 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006427
6428 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006429 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006430 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006431 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006432 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006433
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006434 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6435 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6436 // simplified.
6437 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6438 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6439 break;
6440
6441 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006442
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006443 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6444 // comparison cannot succeed.
6445 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6446 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6447 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6448 else
6449 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6450
6451 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6452 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6453 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6454 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6455 }
6456
6457 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6458 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6459 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006460 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6461 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006462 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6463 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6464 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6465 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006466
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006467 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006468 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6469 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6470 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006471
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006472 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006473 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006474 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6475 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6476 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6477 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006478 }
6479 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006480 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006481
6482 case Instruction::SDiv:
6483 case Instruction::UDiv:
6484 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6485 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6486 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6487 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6488 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6489 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006490 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6491 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6492 DivRHS))
6493 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006494 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006495
6496 case Instruction::Add:
6497 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6498
6499 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6500 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6501 if (!LHSC) break;
6502 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6503
6504 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6505 .subtract(LHSV);
6506
6507 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6508 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6509 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6510 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6511 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6512 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6513 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6514 }
6515 } else {
6516 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6517 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6518 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6519 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6520 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6521 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6522 }
6523 }
6524 }
6525 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006526 }
6527
6528 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6529 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6530 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6531
6532 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6533 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6534 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6535 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6536 case Instruction::SRem:
6537 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6538 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6539 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6540 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6541 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006542 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006543 BO->getName());
6544 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6545 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6546 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6547 }
6548 }
6549 break;
6550 case Instruction::Add:
6551 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6552 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6553 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6554 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6555 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6556 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6557 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6558 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6559 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6560
6561 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6562 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6563 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6564 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6565 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006566 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006567 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6568 Neg->takeName(BO);
6569 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6570 }
6571 }
6572 break;
6573 case Instruction::Xor:
6574 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6575 // the explicit xor.
6576 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6577 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6578 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6579
6580 // FALLTHROUGH
6581 case Instruction::Sub:
6582 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6583 if (RHSV == 0)
6584 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6585 BO->getOperand(1));
6586 break;
6587
6588 case Instruction::Or:
6589 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6590 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6591 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6592 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6593 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6595 isICMP_NE));
6596 }
6597 break;
6598
6599 case Instruction::And:
6600 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6601 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6602 // comparison can never succeed!
6603 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6605 isICMP_NE));
6606
6607 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6608 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6609 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6610 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6611 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6612
6613 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006614 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006615 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6616 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6617 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6618 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6619 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6620 }
6621
6622 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6623 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6624 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6625 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6626 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6627 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6628 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6629 }
6630 }
6631 default: break;
6632 }
6633 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6634 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6635 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6636 AddToWorkList(II);
6637 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6638 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6639 return &ICI;
6640 }
6641 }
6642 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006643 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6644 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006645 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6646 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6647 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6648 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6649 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6650 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6651 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6652 // smaller constant values.
6653 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6654 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6655 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6656 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6657 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6658 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6659 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6660 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6661 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6662 }
6663 }
6664 }
6665 }
6666 return 0;
6667}
6668
6669/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6670/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6671///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006672Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6673 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006674 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6675 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006676 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006677 Value *RHSCIOp;
6678
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006679 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6680 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6681 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6682 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6683 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6684 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6685 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006686 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006687 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6688 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6689 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6690 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006691 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006692 }
6693
6694 if (RHSOp)
6695 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6696 }
6697
6698 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6699 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006700 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6701 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006702 return 0;
6703
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006704 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6705 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006706
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006707 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006708 // Not an extension from the same type?
6709 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006710 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6711 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006712
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006713 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006714 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6715 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6716 return 0;
6717
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006718 // Deal with equality cases early.
6719 if (ICI.isEquality())
6720 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6721
6722 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6723 // signed comparison.
6724 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6725 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6726
6727 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6728 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006729 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006730
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006731 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6732 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6733 if (!CI)
6734 return 0;
6735
6736 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6737 // reextended to DestTy.
6738 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6739 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6740
6741 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6742 if (Res2 == CI) {
6743 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6744 // For example, we might have:
6745 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6746 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6747 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6748 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6749 // because %A may have negative value.
6750 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006751 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6752 // signless.
6753 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006754 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006755 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006756 }
6757
6758 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6759 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6760
6761 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6762 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6763 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006764 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006765 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006766 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006767
6768 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6769 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6770 Value *Result;
6771 if (isSignedCmp) {
6772 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006773 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006774 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006775 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006776 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006777 } else {
6778 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6779 if (isSignedExt) {
6780 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6781 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006782 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006783 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6784 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6785 } else {
6786 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006787 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006788 }
6789 }
6790
6791 // Finally, return the value computed.
6792 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006793 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006794 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006795
6796 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6797 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6798 "ICmp should be folded!");
6799 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6801 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006802}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006803
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006804Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6805 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6806}
6807
6808Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6809 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6810}
6811
6812Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006813 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6814 return R;
6815
6816 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6817
6818 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6819 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6820 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6822
6823 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006824 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6825 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006826 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006827 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006828
6829 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006830}
6831
6832Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6833 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006834 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006835
6836 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6837 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006838 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006839 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006841
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006842 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6843 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006845 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6847 }
6848 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006849 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6851 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006852 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006853 }
6854
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006855 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6856 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6857 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006858 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006859 return R;
6860
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006861 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006862 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6863 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006864 return 0;
6865}
6866
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006867Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006868 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006869 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006870
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006871 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6872 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006873 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6874 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6875 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006876 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6877 return &I;
6878
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006879 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6880 // of a signed value.
6881 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006882 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006883 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6885 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006886 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006887 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006888 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006889 }
6890
6891 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6892 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6893 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6894 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006895 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006896 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6897
6898 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6899 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6900 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6901 return R;
6902 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6903 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6904 return NV;
6905
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006906 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6907 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6908 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6909 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6910 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6911 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6912 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6913 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6914 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6915 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6916 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6917 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006918 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006919 I.getName());
6920 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6921
6922 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6923 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6924 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6925 // other xforms later if dead.
6926 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6927 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6928 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6929
6930 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6931 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6932 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6933 // mask as appropriate.
6934 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6935 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6936 else {
6937 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6938 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6939 }
6940
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006941 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006942 TI->getName());
6943 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6944
6945 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6946 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6947 }
6948 }
6949
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006950 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006951 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6952 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6953 Value *V1, *V2;
6954 ConstantInt *CC;
6955 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006956 default: break;
6957 case Instruction::Add:
6958 case Instruction::And:
6959 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006960 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006961 // These operators commute.
6962 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006963 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6964 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006965 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006966 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006967 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006968 Op0BO->getName());
6969 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006970 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006971 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006972 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006973 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006974 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006975 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006976 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006977 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006978
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006979 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006980 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006981 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006982 match(Op0BOOp1,
6983 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006984 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6985 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006986 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006987 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6988 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006989 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6990 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006991 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006992 V1->getName()+".mask");
6993 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6994
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006995 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006996 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006997 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006998
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006999 // FALL THROUGH.
7000 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007001 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007002 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7003 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007004 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007005 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007006 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7007 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007008 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007009 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007010 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007011 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007012 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007013 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007014 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007015 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007016 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007017
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007018 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007019 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7020 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7021 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007022 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007023 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7024 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007025 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007026 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7027 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007028 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7029 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007030 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007031 V1->getName()+".mask");
7032 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7033
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007034 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007035 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007036
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007037 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007038 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007039 }
7040
7041
7042 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7043 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7044 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7045 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7046 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7047
7048 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007049 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007050 case Instruction::Add:
7051 isValid = isLeftShift;
7052 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007053 case Instruction::Or:
7054 case Instruction::Xor:
7055 highBitSet = false;
7056 break;
7057 case Instruction::And:
7058 highBitSet = true;
7059 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007060 }
7061
7062 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7063 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7064 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7065 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7066 // operation.
7067 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007068 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007069 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007070
7071 if (isValid) {
7072 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
7073
7074 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007075 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007076 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007077 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007078
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007079 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007080 NewRHS);
7081 }
7082 }
7083 }
7084 }
7085
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007086 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007087 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7088 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7089 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007090
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007091 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007092 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007093 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7094 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007095 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7096 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7097 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007098
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007099 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00007100 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7101 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007102
7103 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7104
7105 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007106 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007107 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007108 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7109 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7110 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7111 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007112 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007113 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7114 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7115 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7116 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007117 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007118 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7119
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007120 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007121 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007122 }
7123
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007124 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7125 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7126 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7127 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7128 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007129 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007130 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007131 }
7132 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7133 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007134 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007135 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007136 }
7137 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7138 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7139 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7140 // generators.
7141 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7142 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007143 case 1 :
7144 case 8 :
7145 case 16 :
7146 case 32 :
7147 case 64 :
7148 case 128:
7149 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7150 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007151 default: break;
7152 }
7153 if (SExtType) {
7154 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7155 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7156 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7157 }
7158 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7159 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007160 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007161
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007162 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007163 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7164 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7165 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007166 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007167 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007168 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7169
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007170 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007171 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007172 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007173
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007174 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007175 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7176 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7177 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007178 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007179 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007180
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007181 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007182 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007183 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007184
7185 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7186 } else {
7187 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007188 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007189
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007190 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007191 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7192 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7193 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7194 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007195 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007196 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7197 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7198
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007199 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007200 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007201 }
7202
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007203 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007204 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7205 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7206 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007207 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007208 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7209
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007210 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007211 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007212 }
7213
7214 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007215 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007216 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007217 return 0;
7218}
7219
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007220
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007221/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7222/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7223/// X*Scale+Offset.
7224///
7225static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007226 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007227 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007228 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007229 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007230 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007231 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007232 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7233 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7234 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7235 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7236 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7237 Offset = 0;
7238 return I->getOperand(0);
7239 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7240 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7241 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7242 Offset = 0;
7243 return I->getOperand(0);
7244 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7245 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7246 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7247 unsigned SubScale;
7248 Value *SubVal =
7249 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7250 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7251 Scale = SubScale;
7252 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007253 }
7254 }
7255 }
7256
7257 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7258 Scale = 1;
7259 Offset = 0;
7260 return Val;
7261}
7262
7263
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007264/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7265/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007266Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007267 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007268 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007269
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007270 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7271 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007272
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007273 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7274 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7275 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7276 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7277 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7278
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007279 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007280 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007281 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007282 }
7283 }
7284
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007285 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7286 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7287 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7288 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007289
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007290 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7291 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007292 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7293
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007294 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7295 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7296 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7297 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7298
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007299 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7300 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007301 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007302
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007303 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7304 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007305 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7306 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007307 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7308 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7309
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007310 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7311 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007312 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7313 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007314
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007315 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7316 Value *Amt = 0;
7317 if (Scale == 1) {
7318 Amt = NumElements;
7319 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007320 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007321 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7322 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007323 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007324 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007325 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007326 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007327 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007328 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007329 }
7330
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007331 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7332 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007333 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007334 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7335 }
7336
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007337 AllocationInst *New;
7338 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007339 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007340 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007341 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007342 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007343 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007344
7345 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7346 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7347 // die soon.
7348 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7349 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007350 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7351 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7352 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007353 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7354 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7355 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007356 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7357}
7358
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007359/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007360/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7361/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7362/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7363/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7364///
7365/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7366/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007367///
7368/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7369/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7370/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7371/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7372/// efficiently truncated.
7373///
7374/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7375/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7376/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007377bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7378 unsigned CastOpc,
7379 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007380 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7381 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7382 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007383
7384 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007385 if (!I) return false;
7386
7387 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007388
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007389 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7390 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7391 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7392 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7393 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7394 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7395 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7396 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007397 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007398 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7399 return true;
7400 }
7401 }
7402
7403 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7404 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7405 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7406
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007407 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007408 case Instruction::Add:
7409 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007410 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007411 case Instruction::And:
7412 case Instruction::Or:
7413 case Instruction::Xor:
7414 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007415 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7416 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7417 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7418 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007419
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007420 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007421 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7422 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7423 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007424 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7425 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7426 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007427 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7428 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007429 }
7430 break;
7431 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007432 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7433 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7434 // already zeros.
7435 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007436 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7437 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7438 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007439 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007440 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7441 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007442 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7443 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007444 }
7445 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007446 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007447 case Instruction::ZExt:
7448 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007449 case Instruction::Trunc:
7450 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007451 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7452 // of casts in the input.
7453 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007454 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007455 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007456 case Instruction::Select: {
7457 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7458 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7459 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7460 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7461 NumCastsRemoved);
7462 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007463 case Instruction::PHI: {
7464 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7465 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7466 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7467 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7468 NumCastsRemoved))
7469 return false;
7470 return true;
7471 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007472 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007473 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7474 break;
7475 }
7476
7477 return false;
7478}
7479
7480/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7481/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7482/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007483Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007484 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007485 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007486 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007487
7488 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7489 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007490 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007491 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007492 case Instruction::Add:
7493 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007494 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007495 case Instruction::And:
7496 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007497 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007498 case Instruction::AShr:
7499 case Instruction::LShr:
7500 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007501 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007502 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007503 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007504 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007505 break;
7506 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007507 case Instruction::Trunc:
7508 case Instruction::ZExt:
7509 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007510 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007511 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7512 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007513 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7514 return I->getOperand(0);
7515
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007516 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007517 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007518 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007519 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007520 case Instruction::Select: {
7521 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7522 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7523 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7524 break;
7525 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007526 case Instruction::PHI: {
7527 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7528 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7529 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7530 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7531 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7532 }
7533 Res = NPN;
7534 break;
7535 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007536 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007537 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7538 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7539 break;
7540 }
7541
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007542 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007543 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7544}
7545
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007546/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7547Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007548 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7549
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007550 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007551 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007552 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007553 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7554 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7555 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7556 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007557 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007558 }
7559 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007560
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007561 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007562 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7563 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7564 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007565
7566 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007567 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7568 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7569 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007570
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007571 return 0;
7572}
7573
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007574/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7575Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7576 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7577
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007578 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007579 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7580 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007581 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7582 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7583 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7584 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007585 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007586 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7587 return &CI;
7588 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007589
7590 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7591 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7592 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7593 // non-type-safe code.
7594 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7595 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7596 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7597 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7598 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7599
7600 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7601 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7602 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7603 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7604 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7605 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7606
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007607 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7608 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7609 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007610 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007611 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007612 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007613 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7614 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007615
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007616 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7617 if (Offset < 0) {
7618 --FirstIdx;
7619 Offset += TySize;
7620 assert(Offset >= 0);
7621 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007622 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007623 }
7624
7625 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007626
7627 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7628 while (Offset) {
7629 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7630 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007631 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7632 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7633 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007634
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007635 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7636 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7637 } else {
7638 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7639 Offset = 0;
7640 OrigBase = 0;
7641 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007642 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7643 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007644 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007645 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7646 Offset %= EltSize;
7647 } else {
7648 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7649 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007650 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7651 } else {
7652 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7653 Offset = 0;
7654 OrigBase = 0;
7655 }
7656 }
7657 if (OrigBase) {
7658 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7659 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7660 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007661 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7662 NewIndices.begin(),
7663 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007664 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7665 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7666
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007667 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7668 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7669 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7670 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7671 }
7672 }
7673 }
7674 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007675 }
7676
7677 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7678}
7679
7680
7681
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007682/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7683/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007684/// cases.
7685/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7686Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7687 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7688 return Result;
7689
7690 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7691 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7692 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007693 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7694 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007695
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007696 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7697 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007698 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7699 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007700 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7701 return &CI;
7702
7703 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7704 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007705 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7706 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007707 return 0;
7708
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007709 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007710 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007711 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7712 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007713 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007714 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007715 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7716 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7717 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7718 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007719 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007720 bool DoXForm;
7721 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7722 default:
7723 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7724 // get here because of the check above.
7725 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7726 case Instruction::Trunc:
7727 DoXForm = true;
7728 break;
7729 case Instruction::ZExt:
7730 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7731 break;
7732 case Instruction::SExt:
7733 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7734 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007735 }
7736
7737 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007738 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7739 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007740 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7741 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7742 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7743 case Instruction::Trunc:
7744 case Instruction::BitCast:
7745 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7747 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7748 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7749 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007750 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7751 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007752 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007753 }
7754 case Instruction::SExt:
7755 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007756 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007757 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7758 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007759 }
7760 }
7761 }
7762
7763 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7764 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7765
7766 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7767 case Instruction::Add:
7768 case Instruction::Mul:
7769 case Instruction::And:
7770 case Instruction::Or:
7771 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007772 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007773 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7774 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7775 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7776 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7777 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007778 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7779 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007780 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007781 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7782 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007783 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007784 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007785 }
7786 }
7787
7788 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7789 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7790 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007791 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007792 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007793 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007794 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007795 }
7796 break;
7797 case Instruction::SDiv:
7798 case Instruction::UDiv:
7799 case Instruction::SRem:
7800 case Instruction::URem:
7801 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7802 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7803 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7804 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7805 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007806 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7807 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007808 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7809 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7810 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7811 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007812 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007813 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7814 }
7815 }
7816 break;
7817
7818 case Instruction::Shl:
7819 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7820 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7821 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7822 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7823 // in the value.
7824 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7825 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007826 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7827 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7828 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007829 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007830 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007831 }
7832 break;
7833 case Instruction::AShr:
7834 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7835 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7836 // simplifications.
7837 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7838 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007839 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007840 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7841 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007842 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007843 }
7844 }
7845 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007846 }
7847 return 0;
7848}
7849
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007850Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007851 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7852 return Result;
7853
7854 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7855 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007856 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7857 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007858
7859 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7860 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7861 default: break;
7862 case Instruction::LShr:
7863 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7864 // are already zeros.
7865 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007866 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007867
7868 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007869 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007870 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7871 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007872 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7873 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7874
7875 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7876 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007877 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7878 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7879 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007880 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007881 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007882 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7883
7884 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7885 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7886 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007887 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007888 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7889
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007890 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007891 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007892 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007893 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007894 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7895 "tmp"), CI);
7896 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007897 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007898 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007899 }
7900 break;
7901 }
7902 }
7903
7904 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007905}
7906
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007907/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7908/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7909Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7910 bool DoXform) {
7911 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7912 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7913 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7914 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7915 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7916
7917 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7918 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7919 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7920 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7921 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7922
7923 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7924 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7925 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007926 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007927 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7928 CI);
7929 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007930 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007931 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7932
7933 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7934 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007935 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007936 In->getName()+".not"),
7937 CI);
7938 }
7939
7940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7941 }
7942
7943
7944
7945 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7946 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7947 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7948 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7949 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7950 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7951 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7952 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7953 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7954 // This only works for EQ and NE
7955 ICI->isEquality()) {
7956 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7957 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7958 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7959 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7960 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7961
7962 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7963 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7964 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7965
7966 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7967 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7968 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7969 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7970 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7971 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7973 }
7974
7975 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7976 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7977 if (ShiftAmt) {
7978 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7979 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007980 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007981 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7982 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7983 }
7984
7985 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7986 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007987 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007988 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7989 }
7990
7991 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7993 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007994 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007995 }
7996 }
7997 }
7998
7999 return 0;
8000}
8001
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008002Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008003 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8004 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8005 return Result;
8006
8007 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8008
8009 // If this is a cast of a cast
8010 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008011 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8012 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8013 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8014 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
8015 // Get the sizes of the types involved
8016 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008017 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8018 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8019 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008020 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
8021 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
8022 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00008023 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00008024 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008025 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008026 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008027 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
8028 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
8029 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8030 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008031 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008032 }
8033 return And;
8034 }
8035 }
8036 }
8037
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008038 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8039 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008040
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008041 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8042 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8043 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8044 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8045 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8046 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8047 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8048 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8049 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8050 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8051 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008052 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008053 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008054 }
8055
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008056 return 0;
8057}
8058
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008059Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008060 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8061 return I;
8062
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008063 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8064
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008065 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8066 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8067 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
8068 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8069 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008070
8071 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8072 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8073 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8074 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8075 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8076 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8077 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8078 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8079
8080 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8081 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8082 // bits, it is already ready.
8083 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8084 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8085 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8086 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8087 // bits, just sext from i32.
8088 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8089 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8090 } else {
8091 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8092 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8093 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8094 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8095 }
8096 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008097
8098 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8099 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8100 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8101 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8102 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8103 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8104 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8105 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8106 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8107 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8108 // into:
8109 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8110 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8111 Value *A = 0;
8112 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8113 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8114 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8115 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8116 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8117 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8118 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8119 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8120 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8121 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8122 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8123 CI.getName()), CI);
8124 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8125 }
8126 }
8127
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008128 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008129}
8130
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008131/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8132/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008133static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008134 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008135 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008136 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8137 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008138 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008139 return 0;
8140}
8141
8142/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8143/// through it until we get the source value.
8144static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8145 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8146 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8147 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8148
8149 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8150 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8151 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8152 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8153 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8154 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8155 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008156 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008157 return V;
8158 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8159 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008160 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008161 return V;
8162 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8163 }
8164
8165 return V;
8166}
8167
8168Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8169 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8170 return I;
8171
8172 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8173 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8174 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8175 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8176 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8177 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8178 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8179 default: break;
8180 case Instruction::Add:
8181 case Instruction::Sub:
8182 case Instruction::Mul:
8183 case Instruction::FDiv:
8184 case Instruction::FRem:
8185 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8186 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8187 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8188 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8189 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8190 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8191 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8192 // the cast, do this xform.
8193 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8194 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8195 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8196 CI.getType(), CI);
8197 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8198 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008199 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008200 }
8201 }
8202 break;
8203 }
8204 }
8205 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008206}
8207
8208Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8209 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8210}
8211
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008212Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008213 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8214 if (OpI == 0)
8215 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8216
8217 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8218 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8219 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8220 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8221 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8222 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8223 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8224 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8225 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8226 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008228
8229 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008230}
8231
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008232Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008233 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8234 if (OpI == 0)
8235 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8236
8237 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8238 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8239 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8240 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8241 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8242 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8243 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8244 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8245 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8246 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008248
8249 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008250}
8251
8252Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8253 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8254}
8255
8256Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8257 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8258}
8259
8260Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008261 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008262}
8263
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008264Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8265 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8266 return I;
8267
8268 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8269 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8270
8271 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8272 ConstantInt *Cst;
8273 Value *X;
8274 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8275 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8276 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8277 // is a single-index GEP.
8278 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8279 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008280 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008281
8282 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8283 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8284 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8285
8286 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8287 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8288 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008289 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008290 }
8291 }
8292 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8293 // struct etc.
8294 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8295 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8296 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8297 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8298
8299 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8300 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8301
8302 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8303 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8304 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8305
8306 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8307 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8308 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8309
8310 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8311 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008312 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008313 }
8314 }
8315 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008316}
8317
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008318Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008319 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8320 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8321 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8322 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8323 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8324
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008325 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008326 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8327 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008328 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8329 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8330 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008331 } else {
8332 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8333 return Result;
8334 }
8335
8336
8337 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8338 // be replaced by the operand.
8339 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8341
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008342 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008343 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8344 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8345 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8346
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008347 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8348 // required for changing types.
8349 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8350 return 0;
8351
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008352 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8353 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8354 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8355 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8356 return V;
8357
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008358 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8359 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008360 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8361 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8362 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8363 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8364 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8365 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8366 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8367 ++NumZeros;
8368 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008369
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008370 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8371 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8372 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008373 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8374 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008375 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008376 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008377
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008378 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8379 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8380 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8381 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008382 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008383 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8384 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8385 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8386 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008387 CastInst *Tmp;
8388 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8389 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8390 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8391 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8392 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8393 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8394 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008395 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8396 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8397 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8398 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008399 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8400 // know the vector types match #elts.
8401 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008402 }
8403 }
8404 }
8405 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008406 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008407}
8408
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008409/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8410/// %C = or %A, %B
8411/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8412/// into:
8413/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8414/// %D = or %A, %C
8415///
8416/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8417/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8418/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8419///
8420static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8421 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8422 case Instruction::Add:
8423 case Instruction::Mul:
8424 case Instruction::And:
8425 case Instruction::Or:
8426 case Instruction::Xor:
8427 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8428 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8429 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008430 case Instruction::LShr:
8431 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008432 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008433 default:
8434 return 0; // Cannot fold
8435 }
8436}
8437
8438/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8439/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8440static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8441 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8442 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8443 case Instruction::Add:
8444 case Instruction::Sub:
8445 case Instruction::Or:
8446 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008447 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008448 case Instruction::LShr:
8449 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008450 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008451 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008452 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008453 case Instruction::Mul:
8454 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8455 }
8456}
8457
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008458/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8459/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8460Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8461 Instruction *FI) {
8462 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8463 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8464 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008465 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008466 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8467 return 0;
8468 } else {
8469 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8470 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008471
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008472 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008473 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8474 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008475 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008476 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008477 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008478 }
8479
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008480 // Only handle binary operators here.
8481 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008482 return 0;
8483
8484 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8485 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8486 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8487 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8488 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8489 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8490 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8491 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8492 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8493 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8494 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8495 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8496 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8497 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8498 return 0;
8499 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8500 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8501 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8502 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8503 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8504 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8505 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8506 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8507 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8508 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8509 } else {
8510 return 0;
8511 }
8512
8513 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008514 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8515 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008516 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8517
8518 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8519 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008520 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008521 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008522 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008523 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008524 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8525 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008526}
8527
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008528/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8529/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8530///
8531Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8532 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8533 bool Changed = false;
8534 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8535 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8536 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8537 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8538 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8539
8540 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8541 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8542 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8543 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008544 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008545 switch (Pred) {
8546 default: break;
8547 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8549 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8550 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8551 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8552 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8553 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8554 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8555 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8556 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8557 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8558 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8559 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8560 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8561 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8562 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8563 Changed = true;
8564 }
8565 break;
8566 }
8567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8569 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8570 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8571 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8572 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8573 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8574 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8575 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8576 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8577 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8578 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8579 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8580 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8581 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8582 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8583 Changed = true;
8584 }
8585 break;
8586 }
8587 }
8588
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008589 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
8590 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
8591 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8592 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(0)) &&
8593 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)))
8594 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
8595 else if (!match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)) ||
8596 !match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(0)))
8597 Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
8598 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
8599 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8600 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8601 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8602 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
8603
8604 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
8605 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
8606 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8607 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8608 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8609 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8610 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
8611 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
8612 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8613 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00008614 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
8615 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008616 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
8617
8618 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8619 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
8620 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
8621
8622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
8623 }
8624 }
8625 }
8626
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008627 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8628 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8629 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8630 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8631 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8632 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8633 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8634 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8635
8636 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8637 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8638 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8640 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8641 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8642 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8643 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8644 }
8645
8646 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8647
8648 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8649}
8650
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008651Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008652 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8653 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8654 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8655
8656 // select true, X, Y -> X
8657 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008658 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008660
8661 // select C, X, X -> X
8662 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8663 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8664
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008665 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8667 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8669 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8670 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8672 else
8673 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8674 }
8675
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008676 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008677 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008678 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008679 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008680 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008681 } else {
8682 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8683 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008684 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008685 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008686 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008687 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008688 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008689 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008690 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008691 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008692 } else {
8693 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8694 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008695 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008696 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008697 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008698 }
8699 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008700
8701 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8702 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8703 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008704 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008705 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008706 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008707 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008708
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008709 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8710 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8711 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008712 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008713 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008714 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008715 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008716 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008717 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008718 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008719 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008720 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008721 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008722
8723 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008724
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008725 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008726
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008727 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008728 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008729 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008730 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008731 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008732 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008733 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008734 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008735 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008736 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008737 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008738 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8739
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008740 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8741 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8742 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008743 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8744 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008745 if (SRASize < SISize)
8746 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8747 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8748 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008749 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008750 }
8751 }
8752
8753
8754 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008755 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008756 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8757 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008758 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008759 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008760 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8761 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8762 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008763 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8764 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8765 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008766 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8767 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008768 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8769 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008770 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008771 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008772 Value *V = ICA;
8773 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008774 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008775 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8777 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008778 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008779 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008780
8781 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008782 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8783 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008784 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008785 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8786 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8787 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8788 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8789 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8790 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8791 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8792 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8793 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008794 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008795 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008796 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008797 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008798 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008799 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008800
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008801 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008802 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008803 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8804 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8805 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8806 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8807 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8808 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8809 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8810 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8811 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8813 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008814 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008815 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008817 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008818 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008819 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008820 }
8821
8822 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008823 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8824 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8825 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008826
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008827 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8828 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8829 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008830 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8831
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008832 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8833 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8834 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8835 return IV;
8836
8837 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8838 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008839 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8840 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8841 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8842 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8843 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8844 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8845 }
8846
8847 if (AddOp) {
8848 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8849 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8850 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8851 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8852 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8853 }
8854
8855 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008856 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8857 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8858 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8859 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8860 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8861 } else {
8862 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008863 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008864 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008865
8866 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8867 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8868 if (AddOp != TI)
8869 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8870 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008871 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8872 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008873
8874 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008875 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008876 }
8877 }
8878 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008879
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008880 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008881 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008882 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8883 // transformation we are doing here.
8884 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8885 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8886 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8887 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8888 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8889 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8890 OpToFold = 1;
8891 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8892 OpToFold = 2;
8893 }
8894
8895 if (OpToFold) {
8896 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008897 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008898 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8899 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008900 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008901 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008902 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008903 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008904 else {
8905 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8906 }
8907 }
8908 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008909
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008910 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8911 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8912 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8913 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8914 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8915 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8916 OpToFold = 1;
8917 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8918 OpToFold = 2;
8919 }
8920
8921 if (OpToFold) {
8922 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008923 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008924 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8925 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008926 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008927 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008928 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008929 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008930 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008931 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008932 }
8933 }
8934 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008935
8936 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8937 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8938 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8939 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8940 return &SI;
8941 }
8942
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008943 return 0;
8944}
8945
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008946/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8947/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8948/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8949/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8950/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8951///
8952static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8953 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008954
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008955 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8956 if (!U) return Align;
8957
8958 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8959 default: break;
8960 case Instruction::BitCast:
8961 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8962 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008963 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8964 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008965 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008966 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8967 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008968 AllZeroOperands = false;
8969 break;
8970 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008971
8972 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8973 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008974 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008975 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008976 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008977 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008978 }
8979
8980 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8981 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8982 // of the global.
8983 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8984 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8985 Align = PrefAlign;
8986 }
8987 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8988 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8989 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8990 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8991 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8992 Align = PrefAlign;
8993 }
8994 }
8995
8996 return Align;
8997}
8998
8999/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9000/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9001/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9002/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9003unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9004 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9005 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9006 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9007 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9008 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9009 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9010 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9011 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9012
9013 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9014 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9015
9016 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9017 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009018}
9019
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009020Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009021 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
9022 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009023 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
9024 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9025
9026 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
9027 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
9028 return MI;
9029 }
9030
9031 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9032 // load/store.
9033 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9034 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9035
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009036 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9037 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9038 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9039 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009040 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009041 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9042
9043 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009044 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009045
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009046 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009047 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009048
9049 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9050 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9051 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9052 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9053 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9054 // integer datatype.
9055 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9056 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9057 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9058 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9059 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009060 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009061 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9062 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9063 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9064 else
9065 break;
9066 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9067 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9068 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9069 else
9070 break;
9071 } else
9072 break;
9073 }
9074
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009075 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009076 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
9077 }
9078 }
9079
9080
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009081 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9082 // infer, use it.
9083 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9084 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9085
9086 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9087 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009088 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9089 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9090 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9091
9092 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9093 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
9094 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009095}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009096
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009097Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9098 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
9099 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
9100 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
9101 return MI;
9102 }
9103
9104 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9105 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9106 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9107 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9108 return 0;
9109 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
9110 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9111
9112 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9113 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9114
9115 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9116 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9117 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9118
9119 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9120 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9121
9122 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9123 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9124
9125 // Extract the fill value and store.
9126 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9127 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9128 Alignment), *MI);
9129
9130 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9131 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9132 return MI;
9133 }
9134
9135 return 0;
9136}
9137
9138
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009139/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9140/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9141/// the heavy lifting.
9142///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009143Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009144 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9145 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9146
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009147 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9148 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009149 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009150 bool Changed = false;
9151
9152 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9153 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9154 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9155
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009156 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009157 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009158 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9159 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9160 // alignment is sufficient.
9161 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009162 }
9163
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009164 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9165 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9166 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009167 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009168 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9169 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9170 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009171 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9172 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9173 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00009174 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009175 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9176 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009177 Changed = true;
9178 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009179
9180 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9181 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9182 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009183 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009184
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009185 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9186 // set, update the alignment.
9187 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009188 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9189 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009190 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9191 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9192 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009193 }
9194
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009195 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009196 }
9197
9198 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9199 default: break;
9200 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9201 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9202 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9203 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9204 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9205 break;
9206 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9207 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9208 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9209 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9210 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9211 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9212 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9213 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9214 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9215 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9216 CI);
9217 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009218 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009219 break;
9220 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9221 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9222 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9223 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9224 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9225 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9226 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9227 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9228 }
9229 break;
9230 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9231 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9232 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009233 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9234 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9235 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9236 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9237 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9238 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9239 }
9240 break;
9241
9242 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9243 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9244 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9245 uint64_t UndefElts;
9246 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9247 UndefElts)) {
9248 II->setOperand(1, V);
9249 return II;
9250 }
9251 break;
9252 }
9253
9254 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9255 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9256 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9257 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009258
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009259 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9260 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9261 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9262 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9263 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9264 AllEltsOk = false;
9265 break;
9266 }
9267 }
9268
9269 if (AllEltsOk) {
9270 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9271 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9272 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9273 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009274
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009275 // Only extract each element once.
9276 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9277 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9278
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009279 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009280 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9281 continue;
9282 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9283 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9284
9285 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9286 Instruction *Elt =
9287 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9288 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9289 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009290 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009291
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009292 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9293 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9294 i, "tmp");
9295 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009296 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009297 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009298 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009299 }
9300 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009301
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009302 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9303 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9304 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9305 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9306 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9307 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9308 if (&*++BI == II)
9309 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009310 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009311 }
9312
9313 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9314 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9315 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9316 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9317 bool CannotRemove = false;
9318 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9319 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9320 CannotRemove = true;
9321 break;
9322 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009323 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9324 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9325 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9326 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9327 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9328 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9329 } else {
9330 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9331 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009332 CannotRemove = true;
9333 break;
9334 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009335 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009336 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009337
9338 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9339 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9340 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9341 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9342 break;
9343 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009344 }
9345
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009346 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009347}
9348
9349// InvokeInst simplification
9350//
9351Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009352 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009353}
9354
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009355/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9356/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009357static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9358 const CastInst * const CI,
9359 const TargetData * const TD,
9360 const int ix) {
9361 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9362 return false;
9363
9364 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9365 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9366 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009367 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009368 return true;
9369
9370 const Type* SrcTy =
9371 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9372 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9373 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9374 return false;
9375 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9376 return false;
9377 return true;
9378}
9379
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009380// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9381//
9382Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009383 bool Changed = false;
9384
9385 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9386 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009387 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9388
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009389 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009390
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009391 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9392 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9393 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9394 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9395 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009396 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009397 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9398 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009399 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9400 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9401 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9402 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9403 return 0;
9404 }
9405
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009406 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9407 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9408 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9409 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009410 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009411 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009412 CS.getInstruction());
9413
9414 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9415 CS.getInstruction()->
9416 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9417
9418 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9419 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009420 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9421 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009422 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009423 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9424 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009425
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009426 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9427 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9428 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9429 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9430
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009431 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9432 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9433 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009434 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009435 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9436 // the call.
9437 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009438 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9439 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9440 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9441 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9442 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009443 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009444 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009445 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009446
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009447 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009448 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009449 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009450 Changed = true;
9451 }
9452
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009453 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009454}
9455
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009456// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9457// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9458//
9459bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9460 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9461 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009462 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9463 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009464 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009465 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009466 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009467 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009468
9469 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9470 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9471 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9472 //
9473 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9474 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009475 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009476
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009477 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009478 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9479
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009480 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009481 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009482 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009483 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9484 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9485 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009486 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009487 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009488
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009489 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009490 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009491 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009492 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9493
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009494 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009495 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009496 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009497 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9498 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009499
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009500 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9501 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9502 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9503 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9504 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9505 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9506 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9507 UI != E; ++UI)
9508 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9509 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009510 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009511 return false;
9512 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009513
9514 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9515 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009516
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009517 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9518 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9519 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009520 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009521
9522 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009523 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9524
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009525 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9526 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009527 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009528
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009529 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9530 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009531 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009532 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9533 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009534 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009535 }
9536
9537 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009538 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009539 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009540
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009541 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9542 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009543 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009544 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9545 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009546 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9547 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009548 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009549 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009550 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009551 return false;
9552 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009553
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009554 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9555 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9556 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9557 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009558 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009559 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9560
9561 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009562 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009563
9564 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9565 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009566 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009567
9568 // Add the new return attributes.
9569 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009570 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009571
9572 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9573 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9574 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9575 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9576 Args.push_back(*AI);
9577 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009578 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009579 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009580 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009581 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009582 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009583
9584 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009585 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009586 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009587 }
9588
9589 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9590 // now...
9591 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9592 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9593
9594 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009595 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009596 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009597 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9598 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009599 } else {
9600 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9601 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9602 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9603 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9604 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009605 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9606 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009607 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009608 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9609 Args.push_back(Cast);
9610 } else {
9611 Args.push_back(*AI);
9612 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009613
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009614 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009615 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009616 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009617 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009618 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009619 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009620
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009621 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9622 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9623
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009624 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009625 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009626
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009627 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009628
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009629 Instruction *NC;
9630 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009631 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009632 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9633 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009634 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009635 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009636 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009637 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9638 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009639 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9640 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009641 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009642 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009643 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009644 }
9645
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009646 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009647 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009648 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009649 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009650 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009651 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009652 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009653
9654 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9655 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9656 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009657 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009658 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9659 } else {
9660 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9661 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9662 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009663 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009664 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009665 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009666 }
9667 }
9668
9669 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9670 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009671 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009672 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009673 return true;
9674}
9675
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009676// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9677// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9678//
9679Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9680 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9681 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9682 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009683 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009684
9685 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9686 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009687 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009688 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009689
9690 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9691 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9692
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009693 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009694 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9695 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9696
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009697 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009698 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009699 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9700 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009701 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009702
9703 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9704 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9705 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009706 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009707 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9708 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009709 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009710 break;
9711 }
9712
9713 if (NestTy) {
9714 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9715 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9716 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9717
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009718 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009719 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009720
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009721 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009722 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9723
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009724 // Add any result attributes.
9725 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009726 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009727
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009728 {
9729 unsigned Idx = 1;
9730 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9731 do {
9732 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009733 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009734 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9735 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9736 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9737 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009738 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009739 }
9740
9741 if (I == E)
9742 break;
9743
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009744 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009745 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009746 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009747 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009748 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009749
9750 ++Idx, ++I;
9751 } while (1);
9752 }
9753
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009754 // Add any function attributes.
9755 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9756 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9757
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009758 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9759 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009760 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009761
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009762 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009763 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9764
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009765 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009766 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009767 {
9768 unsigned Idx = 1;
9769 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9770 E = FTy->param_end();
9771
9772 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009773 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9774 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009775 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009776
9777 if (I == E)
9778 break;
9779
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009780 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009781 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009782
9783 ++Idx, ++I;
9784 } while (1);
9785 }
9786
9787 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9788 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9789 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009790 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009791 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9792 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009793 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009794
9795 Instruction *NewCaller;
9796 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009797 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9798 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9799 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9800 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009801 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009802 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009803 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009804 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9805 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009806 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9807 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9808 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9809 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009810 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009811 }
9812 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9813 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9814 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9815 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9816 return 0;
9817 }
9818 }
9819
9820 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9821 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9822 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9823 Constant *NewCallee =
9824 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9825 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9826 return CS.getInstruction();
9827}
9828
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009829/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9830/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9831/// and a single binop.
9832Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9833 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009834 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9835 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009836 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009837 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9838 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9839
9840 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9841 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009842
9843 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9844 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009845 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009846 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009847 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009848 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009849 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9850 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9851 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009852 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009853
9854 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9855 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9856 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9857 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9858 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009859
9860 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9861 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9862 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009863 }
9864
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009865 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9866
9867 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9868 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9869 // hide them behind a phi.
9870 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9871 return 0;
9872
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009873 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009874 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009875 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009876 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009877 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9878 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009879 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9880 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009881 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9882 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9883 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009884
9885 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009886 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9887 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009888 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9889 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009890 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9891 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9892 }
9893
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009894 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9895 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9896 if (NewLHS) {
9897 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9898 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9899 }
9900 if (NewRHS) {
9901 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9902 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9903 }
9904 }
9905
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009906 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009907 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009908 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009909 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009910 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009911 else {
9912 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009913 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009914 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009915}
9916
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009917/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9918/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9919/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9920/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009921///
9922/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9923/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9924/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009925static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9926 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9927
9928 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9929 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9930 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009931
9932 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9933 // profitable to do this xform.
9934 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9935 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9936 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9937 UI != E; ++UI) {
9938 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9939 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9940 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9941 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9942 }
9943 isAddressTaken = true;
9944 break;
9945 }
9946
9947 if (!isAddressTaken)
9948 return false;
9949 }
9950
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009951 return true;
9952}
9953
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009954
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009955// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9956// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9957// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9958Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9959 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9960
9961 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9962 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9963 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9964 // code size and simplifying code.
9965 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9966 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009967 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009968 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9969 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009970 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009971 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9972 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009973 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009974 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9975 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009976 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9977 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9978 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9979 // load and the PHI.
9980 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9981 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9982 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009983
9984 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9985 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9986 // the path through the other successor.
9987 if (isVolatile &&
9988 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9989 return 0;
9990
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009991 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009992 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009993 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9994 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9995 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009996 } else {
9997 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9998 }
9999
10000 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10001 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10002 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10003 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010004 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010005 return 0;
10006 if (CastSrcTy) {
10007 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10008 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010009 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010010 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10011 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010012 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10013 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
10014 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
10015 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010016
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010017 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10018 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10019 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010020 if (isVolatile &&
10021 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10022 return 0;
10023
10024
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010025 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10026 return 0;
10027 }
10028 }
10029
10030 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10031 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010032 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10033 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010034 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010035
10036 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10037 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010038
10039 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010040 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10041 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10042 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10043 InVal = 0;
10044 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10045 }
10046
10047 Value *PhiVal;
10048 if (InVal) {
10049 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10050 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10051 PhiVal = InVal;
10052 delete NewPN;
10053 } else {
10054 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10055 PhiVal = NewPN;
10056 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010057
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010058 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010059 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010060 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010061 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010062 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010063 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010064 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010065 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010066 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10067
10068 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10069 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10070 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10071 if (isVolatile)
10072 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10073 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10074
10075 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010076}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010077
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010078/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10079/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010080static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10081 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010082 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10083 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10084
10085 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010086 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010087 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010088
10089 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10090 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10091 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010092
10093 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10094 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010095
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010096 return false;
10097}
10098
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010099/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10100/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10101/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10102static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10103 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10104 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10105 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10106 return true;
10107
10108 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10109 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10110 return false;
10111
10112 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10113 // the value.
10114 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10115 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10116 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10117 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10118 return false;
10119 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10120 return false;
10121 }
10122
10123 return true;
10124}
10125
10126
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010127// PHINode simplification
10128//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010129Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010130 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010131 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010132
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010133 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10134 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10135
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010136 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10137 // reducing code size.
10138 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10139 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10140 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10141 return Result;
10142
10143 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10144 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10145 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010146 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10147 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10148 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010149 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010150 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10151 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10152 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10153 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010154
10155 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10156 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10157 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10158 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10159 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10160 // late.
10161 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10162 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10163 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10164 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10165 }
10166 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010167
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010168 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10169 // same value, for example:
10170 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10171 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10172 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10173 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10174 {
10175 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10176 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10177 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10178 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10179 ++InValNo;
10180
10181 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10182 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10183
10184 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10185 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10186 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10187 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10188 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10189 break;
10190 }
10191
10192 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10193 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10194 // the value.
10195 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10196 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10197 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10199 }
10200 }
10201 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010202 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010203}
10204
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010205static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10206 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10207 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010208 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10209 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010210 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10211 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10212 // used for address computation.
10213 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10214 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10215 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10216 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010217}
10218
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010219
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010220Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010221 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010222 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010223 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010224 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010226
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010227 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10229
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010230 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10231 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10232 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10233
10234 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010236
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010237 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10238 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010239
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010240 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010241 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10242 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010243 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010244 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010245 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10246 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10247 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10248 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10249 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10250 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10251 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010252 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010253 }
10254 }
10255 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010256 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010257 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10258 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010259 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10260 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010261 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010262 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010263 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010264 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010265 MadeChange = true;
10266 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010267 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10268 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010269 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010270 MadeChange = true;
10271 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010272 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10273 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10274 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10275 MadeChange = true;
10276 } else {
10277 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10278 GEP);
10279 *i = Op;
10280 MadeChange = true;
10281 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010282 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010283 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010284 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010285 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10286
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010287 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10288 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10289 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010290 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10291 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10292 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10293 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10294 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10295 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010296 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10297 if (I != BCI) {
10298 I->takeName(BCI);
10299 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10300 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10301 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010302 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010303 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010304 }
10305 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10306 }
10307 }
10308
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010309 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10310 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10311 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10312 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010313 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010314 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010315 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010316
10317 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010318 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10319 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10320 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10321 //
10322 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10323 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10324 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10325
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010326 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010327
10328 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10329 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10330 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10331 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010332 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010333
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010334 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010335 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010336 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10337 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10338 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010339 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010340 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10341 Sum = GO1;
10342 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10343 Sum = SO1;
10344 } else {
10345 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10346 // target's pointer size.
10347 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10348 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010349 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010350 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010351 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010352 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010353 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10354 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010355 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010356 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010357
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010358 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010359 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010360 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010361 } else {
10362 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010363 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10364 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010365 }
10366 }
10367 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010368 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10369 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10370 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010371 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010372 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010373 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010374 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010375
10376 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10377 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10378 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10379 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10380 return &GEP;
10381 } else {
10382 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10383 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10384 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10385 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10386 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010387 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010388 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010389 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010390 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010391 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10392 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010393 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10394 }
10395
10396 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010397 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10398 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010399
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010400 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010401 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10402 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10403
10404 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010405 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010406 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10407 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10408 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10409
10410 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010411 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10412 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010413
10414 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10415 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10416 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010417 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010418 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10419 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10420 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010421 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10422 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010423 //
10424 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10425 //
10426 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10427 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10428 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10429 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10430 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10431 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10432 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10433 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10434 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10435 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10436 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10437 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10438 return &GEP;
10439 }
10440 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10441 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010442 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10443 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010444 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10445 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10446 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010447 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10448 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010449 Value *Idx[2];
10450 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10451 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010452 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010453 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010454 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10455 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010456 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010457
10458 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010459 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010460 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010461 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010462
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010463 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010464 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010465 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010466
10467 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10468 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10469 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10470 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10471 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10472 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10473 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10474 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010475 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010476 Scale = CI;
10477 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10478 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10479 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010480 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10481 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10482 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010483 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10484 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10485 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10486 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10487 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10488 }
10489 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010490
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010491 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010492 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10493 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10494 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10495 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10496 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10497 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10498 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010499 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010500 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010501 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010502 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010503 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10504 }
10505
10506 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010507 Value *Idx[2];
10508 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10509 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010510 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010511 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010512 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10513 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10514 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010515 }
10516 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010517 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010518 }
10519
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010520 return 0;
10521}
10522
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010523Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10524 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010525 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010526 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10527 const Type *NewTy =
10528 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010529 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010530
10531 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10532 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010533 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010534 else {
10535 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010536 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010537 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010538
10539 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010540
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010541 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10542 // allocas if possible...
10543 //
10544 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10545 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10546
10547 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10548 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10549 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010550 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010551 Value *Idx[2];
10552 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10553 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010554 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10555 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010556
10557 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10558 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010560 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010562 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010563 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010564
10565 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10566 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10567 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010568 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010569 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10571
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010572 return 0;
10573}
10574
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010575Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10576 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10577
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010578 // free undef -> unreachable.
10579 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10580 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010581 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010582 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010583 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10584 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010585
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010586 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10587 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010588 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010589 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010590
10591 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10592 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10593 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10594 return &FI;
10595 }
10596
10597 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10598 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10599 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10600 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10601 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10602 return &FI;
10603 }
10604 }
10605
10606 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10607 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10608 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10609 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10610 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10611 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010612
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010613 return 0;
10614}
10615
10616
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010617/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010618static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010619 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010620 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010621 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010622
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010623 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10624 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10625 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010626 std::string Str;
10627 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010628 unsigned len = Str.length();
10629 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10630 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10631 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10632 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010633 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10634 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10635 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10636 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10637 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10638 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10639 }
10640 } else {
10641 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10642 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10643 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10644 }
10645 // Append NULL at the end.
10646 SingleChar = 0;
10647 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10648 }
10649 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10650 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010651 }
10652 }
10653 }
10654
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010655 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010656 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010657 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010658
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010659 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010660 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010661 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10662 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10663 // constants.
10664 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10665 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10666 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010667 Value *Idxs[2];
10668 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10669 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010670 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10671 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10672 }
10673
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010674 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010675 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010676 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10677 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10678 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010679 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10680 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010681
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010682 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10683 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10684 // the result of the loaded value.
10685 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10686 CI->getName(),
10687 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10688 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010689 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010690 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010691 }
10692 }
10693 return 0;
10694}
10695
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010696/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010697/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10698/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10699/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10700static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010701 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10702 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10703
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010704 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010705 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010706 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010707 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010708
10709 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10710 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010711 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10712 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10713 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010714 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10715
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010716 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010717 --BBI;
10718
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010719 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10720 // marked invalid.
10721 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10722 return false;
10723
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010724 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10725 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010726 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010727 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010728 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010729
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010730 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010731 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010732}
10733
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010734/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
10735/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
10736/// value in code like this:
10737/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10738/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
10739/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10740/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
10741///
10742static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
10743 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
10744 if (A == B) return true;
10745
10746 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
10747 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
10748 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
10749 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
10750 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
10751 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
10752 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
10753 return true;
10754
10755 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
10756 return false;
10757}
10758
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010759Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10760 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010761
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010762 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010763 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10764 if (KnownAlign >
10765 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10766 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010767 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10768
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010769 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010770 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010771 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010772 return Res;
10773
10774 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10775 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010776
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010777 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10778 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10779 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10780 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
10781 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != LI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10782 --ScanInsts) {
10783 --BBI;
10784
10785 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10786 if (equivalentAddressValues(SI->getOperand(1), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010788 } else if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10789 if (equivalentAddressValues(LIB->getOperand(0), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010791 }
10792
10793 // Don't skip over things that can modify memory.
10794 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10795 break;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010796 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010797
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010798 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10799 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10800 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10801 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10802 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010803 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10804 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10805 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10806 // CFG.
10807 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10808 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10810 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010811 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010812
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010813 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010814 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010815 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10816 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10817 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010818 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10819 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10820 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010821 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10822 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010824 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010825
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010826 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10827 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010828 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010830
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010831 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010832 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010833 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10834 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010835 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010836 if (Constant *V =
10837 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010839 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10840 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10841 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10842 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10843 // CFG.
10844 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10845 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10847 }
10848
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010849 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010850 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010851 return Res;
10852 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010853 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010854 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010855
10856 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10857 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010858 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010859 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10860 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10861 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10862 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10864 }
10865 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010866
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010867 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010868 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10869 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10870 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10871 //
10872 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10873 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10874 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10875 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10876 // unconditionally.
10877 //
10878 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10879 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010880 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10881 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010882 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010883 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010884 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010885 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010886 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010887 }
10888
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010889 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10890 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10891 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10892 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10893 return &LI;
10894 }
10895
10896 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10897 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10898 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10899 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10900 return &LI;
10901 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010902 }
10903 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010904 return 0;
10905}
10906
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010907/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010908/// when possible.
10909static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10910 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10911 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10912
10913 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10914 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10915 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10916
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010917 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010918 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10919 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10920 // constants.
10921 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10922 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10923 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010924 Value* Idxs[2];
10925 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10926 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010927 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10928 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10929 }
10930
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010931 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10932 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10933 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010934
10935 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010936 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10937 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010938 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010939 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010940 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10941 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10942 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10943 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10944 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010945 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010946 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010947 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010948 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10949 }
10950 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010951 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010952 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010953 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010954 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010955 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010956 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10957 }
10958 }
10959 }
10960 return 0;
10961}
10962
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010963Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10964 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10965 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10966
10967 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010968 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010969 ++NumCombined;
10970 return 0;
10971 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010972
10973 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10974 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010975 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010976 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10977 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10978 ++NumCombined;
10979 return 0;
10980 }
10981
10982 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10983 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10984 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10985 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10986 ++NumCombined;
10987 return 0;
10988 }
10989 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010990
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010991 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010992 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10993 if (KnownAlign >
10994 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10995 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010996 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10997
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010998 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10999 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11000 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11001 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11002 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11003 --ScanInsts) {
11004 --BBI;
11005
11006 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11007 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011008 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11009 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011010 ++NumDeadStore;
11011 ++BBI;
11012 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11013 continue;
11014 }
11015 break;
11016 }
11017
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011018 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11019 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11020 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11021 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011022 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11023 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011024 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11025 ++NumCombined;
11026 return 0;
11027 }
11028 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11029 // may not be dead.
11030 break;
11031 }
11032
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011033 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011034 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011035 break;
11036 }
11037
11038
11039 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011040
11041 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
11042 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
11043 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11044 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
11045 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011046 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011047 ++NumCombined;
11048 }
11049 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11050 }
11051
11052 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11053 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011054 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011055 ++NumCombined;
11056 return 0;
11057 }
11058
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011059 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11060 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011061 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011062 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11063 return Res;
11064 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011065 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011066 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11067 return Res;
11068
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011069
11070 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
11071 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011072 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011073 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011074 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11075 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11076 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011077
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011078 return 0;
11079}
11080
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011081/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11082/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11083/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11084///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011085/// Simplify things like:
11086/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11087/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11088///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011089bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11090 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11091
11092 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11093 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11094 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011095 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011096
11097 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11098 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011099 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11100 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011101 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011102 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011103 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011104 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011105 return false;
11106
11107 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011108 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011109 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011110 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011111 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011112 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011113 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011114
11115 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11116 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11117 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11118 return false;
11119
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011120 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11121 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011122 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011123 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011124 return false;
11125
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011126 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11127 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11128 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11129 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11130 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11131 --BBI;
11132 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11133 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11134 return false;
11135 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011136 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011137 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11138 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11139 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11140 return false;
11141
11142 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011143 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11144 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011145 for (;; --BBI) {
11146 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11147 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11148 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11149 return false;
11150 break;
11151 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011152 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11153 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11154 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011155 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11156 return false;
11157 }
11158
11159 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011160 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11161 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011162 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11163 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011164 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011165 return false;
11166 }
11167 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011168
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011169 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011170 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11171 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011172 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011173 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11174 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011175 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11176 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011177 }
11178
11179 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11180 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011181 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011182 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11183 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11184
11185 // Nuke the old stores.
11186 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11187 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11188 ++NumCombined;
11189 return true;
11190}
11191
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011192
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011193Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11194 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011195 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011196 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11197 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11198 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11199 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11200 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11201 BI.setCondition(X);
11202 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11203 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11204 return &BI;
11205 }
11206
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011207 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11208 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11209 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11210 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11211 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11212 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11213 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011214 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011215 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11216 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011217 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11218 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11219 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11220 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011221 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011222 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011223 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011224 return &BI;
11225 }
11226
11227 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11228 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11229 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11230 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11231 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11232 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11233 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11234 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011235 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011236 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11237 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011238 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011239 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011240 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11241 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011242 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011243 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011244 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011245 return &BI;
11246 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011247
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011248 return 0;
11249}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011250
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011251Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11252 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11253 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11254 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11255 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11256 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11257 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011258 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011259 AddRHS));
11260 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011261 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011262 return &SI;
11263 }
11264 }
11265 return 0;
11266}
11267
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011268Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011269 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011270
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011271 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11272 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11273
11274 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11275 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11276 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11277
11278 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11280
11281 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11282 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11283 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11284 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11285 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11286 // first index
11287 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11288 else
11289 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11290 }
11291 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11292 }
11293 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11294 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11295 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11296 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11297 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11298 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11299 ++exti, ++insi) {
11300 if (*insi != *exti)
11301 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11302 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11303 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11304 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11305 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11306 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11307 // with
11308 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11309 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11310 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11311 }
11312 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11313 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11314 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11315 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11316 // with "i32 42"
11317 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11318 if (exti == exte) {
11319 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11320 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11321 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11322 // with
11323 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11324 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11325 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11326 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11327 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11328 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11329 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11330 EV);
11331 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11332 insi, inse);
11333 }
11334 if (insi == inse)
11335 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11336 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11337 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11338 // i.e., replace
11339 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11340 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11341 // with
11342 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11343 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11344 exti, exte);
11345 }
11346 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11347 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11348 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11349 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011350 return 0;
11351}
11352
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011353/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11354/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11355static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11356 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11357 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011358 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011359 if (isConstant) return true;
11360 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11361 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11362 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11363 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11364 return false;
11365 return true;
11366 }
11367 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11368 if (!I) return false;
11369
11370 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11371 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11372 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11373 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11374 return true;
11375 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11376 return true;
11377 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11378 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11379 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11380 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11381 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011382 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11383 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11384 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11385 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11386 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011387
11388 return false;
11389}
11390
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011391/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11392///
11393/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11394/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011395static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11396 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11397 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11398 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11399 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11400 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11401
11402 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011403 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011404 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11405 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011406 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11407 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011408 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011409 return Result;
11410}
11411
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011412/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11413/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11414/// extracted from the vector.
11415static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011416 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11417 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011418 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11419 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011420 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11421
11422 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11423 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11424 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11425 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011426 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011427 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11428 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11429 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011430 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11431 return 0;
11432 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011433
11434 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11435 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011436 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11437 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011438
11439 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11440 // vector input.
11441 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011442 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011443 unsigned LHSWidth =
11444 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011445 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011446 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011447 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011448 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
11449 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011450 else
11451 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011452 }
11453
11454 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11455 return 0;
11456}
11457
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011458Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011459 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011460 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11462
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011463 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011464 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11465 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11466
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011467 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011468 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11469 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11470 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011471 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011472 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011473 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11474 op0 = 0;
11475 break;
11476 }
11477 if (op0)
11478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011479 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011480
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011481 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11482 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011483 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011484 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11485 unsigned VectorWidth =
11486 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11487
11488 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11489 // crashing the code below.
11490 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11492
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011493 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11494 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11495 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011496 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011497 uint64_t UndefElts;
11498 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011499 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011500 UndefElts)) {
11501 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11502 return &EI;
11503 }
11504 }
11505
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011506 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011508
11509 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11510 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11511 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11512 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11513 if (const VectorType *VT =
11514 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11515 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11516 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11517 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11518 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011519 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011520
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011521 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011522 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11523 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11524 // profitable to do so
11525 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011526 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11527 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11528 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11529 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11530 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11531 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11532 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11533 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11534 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11535 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011536 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011537 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011538 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011539 unsigned AS =
11540 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011541 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11542 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011543 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11544 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011545 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11546 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011547 }
11548 }
11549 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11550 // Extracting the inserted element?
11551 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11553 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11554 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11555 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11556 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11557 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11558 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11559 return &EI;
11560 }
11561 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11562 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11563 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011564 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11565 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011566 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011567 unsigned LHSWidth =
11568 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11569
11570 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011571 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011572 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
11573 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011574 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11575 } else {
11576 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011577 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011578 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011579 }
11580 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011581 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011582 return 0;
11583}
11584
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011585/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11586/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11587/// Otherwise, return false.
11588static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11589 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11590 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11591 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011592 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011593
11594 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011595 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011596 return true;
11597 } else if (V == LHS) {
11598 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011599 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011600 return true;
11601 } else if (V == RHS) {
11602 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011603 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011604 return true;
11605 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11606 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11607 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11608 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11609 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11610
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011611 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11612 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011613 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011614
11615 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11616 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11617 // transitively ok.
11618 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11619 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011620 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011621 return true;
11622 }
11623 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11624 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011625 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11626 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011627 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011628
11629 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11630 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11631 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11632 // transitively ok.
11633 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11634 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11635 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011636 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011637 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011638 } else {
11639 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011640 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011641 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011642
11643 }
11644 return true;
11645 }
11646 }
11647 }
11648 }
11649 }
11650 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11651
11652 return false;
11653}
11654
11655/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11656/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11657/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011658static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011659 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011660 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011661 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011662 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011663 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011664
11665 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011666 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011667 return V;
11668 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011669 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011670 return V;
11671 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11672 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11673 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11674 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11675 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11676
11677 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11678 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11679 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11680 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011681 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11682 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011683
11684 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11685 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011686 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11687 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11688 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011689 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011690 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011691 return V;
11692 }
11693
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011694 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11695 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011696 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11697 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11698 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011699 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011700 }
11701 return V;
11702 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011703
11704 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11705 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11706 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11707 return EI->getOperand(0);
11708
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011709 }
11710 }
11711 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011712 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011713
11714 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11715 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011716 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011717 return V;
11718}
11719
11720Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11721 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11722 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11723 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11724
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011725 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11726 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11727 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11728
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011729 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11730 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11731 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11732 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11733 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11734 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011735 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11736 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011737 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011738
11739 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11740 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11741
11742 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11743 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11744
11745 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11746 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11747 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11748 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11749
11750 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11751 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11752 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11753 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11754 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11755 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11756 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11757 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11758 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11759 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011760 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011761 else {
11762 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011763 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011764 NumVectorElts));
11765 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011766 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011767 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011768 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011769 }
11770
11771 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11772 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11773 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11774 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011775 Value *RHS = 0;
11776 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11777 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11778 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011779 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011780 }
11781 }
11782 }
11783
11784 return 0;
11785}
11786
11787
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011788Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11789 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11790 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011791 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011792
11793 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011794
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011795 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011796 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011798
11799 uint64_t UndefElts;
11800 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011801
11802 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
11803 return 0;
11804
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011805 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11806 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011807 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11808 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11809 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011810 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011811 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011812
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011813 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11814 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11815 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11816 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011817 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11818 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11819 }
11820
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011821 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11822 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11823 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011824 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011825 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011826 else {
11827 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011828 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011829 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011830 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11831 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011832 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011833 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11834 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011835 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011836 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011837 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011838 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011839 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011840 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11841 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011842 MadeChange = true;
11843 }
11844
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011845 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011846 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011847
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011848 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11849 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11850 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11851 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11852
11853 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11854 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011855 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011856
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011857 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11858 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11859 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011860
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011861 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11862 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11863 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11864 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11865 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11866 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11867 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11868 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11869 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11870 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11871 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11872 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11873
11874 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11875 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11876 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11877 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11878 else
11879 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11880
11881 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11882 // the replacement.
11883 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11884 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11885 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11886 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011887 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011888 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011889 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011890 }
11891 }
11892 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11893 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011894 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011895 }
11896 }
11897 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011898
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011899 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11900}
11901
11902
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011903
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011904
11905/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11906/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11907/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11908/// end of its block.
11909static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11910 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11911
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011912 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011913 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11914 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011915
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011916 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011917 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11918 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011919 return false;
11920
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011921 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11922 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011923 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11924 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011925 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11926 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11927 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011928 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011929
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011930 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011931
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011932 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011933 ++NumSunkInst;
11934 return true;
11935}
11936
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011937
11938/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11939/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11940///
11941/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11942/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11943/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11944/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11945/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11946///
11947static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011948 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011949 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011950 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011951 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011952 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011953
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011954 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11955 BB = Worklist.back();
11956 Worklist.pop_back();
11957
11958 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11959 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11960
11961 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11962 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011963
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011964 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11965 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11966 ++NumDeadInst;
11967 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11968 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11969 continue;
11970 }
11971
11972 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11973 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11974 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11975 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11976 ++NumConstProp;
11977 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11978 continue;
11979 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011980
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011981 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011982 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011983
11984 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11985 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11986 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11987 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11988 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11989 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011990 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011991 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011992 continue;
11993 }
11994 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11995 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11996 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11997 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11998 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011999 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012000 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012001 continue;
12002 }
12003
12004 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12005 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12006 continue;
12007 }
12008 }
12009
12010 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12011 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012012 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012013}
12014
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012015bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012016 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000012017 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012018
12019 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12020 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012021
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012022 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012023 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12024 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12025 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012026 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012027 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012028
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012029 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12030 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12031 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12032 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12033 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12034 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12035 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12036 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012037
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012038 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012039 ++NumDeadInst;
12040
12041 if (!I->use_empty())
12042 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
12043 I->eraseFromParent();
12044 }
12045 }
12046 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012047
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012048 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12049 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12050 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012051
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012052 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012053 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012054 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012055 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012056 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012057 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012058
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012059 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012060
12061 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012062 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012063 continue;
12064 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012065
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012066 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000012067 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012068 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012069
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012070 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012071 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012072 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12073
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012074 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012075 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012076 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012077 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012078 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012079
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012080 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
12081 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12082 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
12083 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
12084 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
12085 i->set(NewC);
12086 }
12087 }
12088 }
12089
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012090 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012091 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012092 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12093 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12094 if (UserParent != BB) {
12095 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12096 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12097 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12098 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12099 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12100 break;
12101 }
12102
12103 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12104 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12105 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12106 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12107 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12108 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
12109 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
12110 }
12111 }
12112
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012113 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012114#ifndef NDEBUG
12115 std::string OrigI;
12116#endif
12117 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012118 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012119 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012120 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012121 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012122 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12123 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012124
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012125 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12126 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12127
12128 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012129 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012130 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012131
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012132 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12133 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012134
12135 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12136 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012137 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12138
12139 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12140 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12141 ++InsertPos;
12142
12143 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012144
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012145 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12146 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012147 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000012148
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012149 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12150 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012151 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012152
12153 // Erase the old instruction.
12154 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012155 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012156#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012157 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12158 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012159#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012160
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012161 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12162 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012163 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12164 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12165 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012166 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012167
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012168 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012169 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012170 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012171 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012172 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012173 AddToWorkList(I);
12174 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012175 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012176 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012177 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012178 }
12179 }
12180
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012181 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012182
12183 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12184 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012185 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012186}
12187
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012188
12189bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012190 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12191
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012192 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12193
12194 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12195 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012196 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012197 EverMadeChange = true;
12198 return EverMadeChange;
12199}
12200
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012201FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012202 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012203}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012204
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012205